blob: 601c20e5afc1c93ea6cb0f9ba8458dc539c60c9c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Christopher Faulet1909aa12019-09-27 14:17:42 +02007 2019/09/27
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020055
564. Proxies
574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
584.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
59
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100605. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200615.1. Bind options
625.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200635.3. Server DNS resolution
645.3.1. Global overview
655.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020066
676. HTTP header manipulation
68
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200697. Using ACLs and fetching samples
707.1. ACL basics
717.1.1. Matching booleans
727.1.2. Matching integers
737.1.3. Matching strings
747.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
757.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
787.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200797.3.1. Converters
807.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
817.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
827.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
837.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
847.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200857.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086
878. Logging
888.1. Log levels
898.2. Log formats
908.2.1. Default log format
918.2.2. TCP log format
928.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100938.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100948.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200958.3. Advanced logging options
968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
978.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
988.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1008.4. Timing events
1018.5. Session state at disconnection
1028.6. Non-printable characters
1038.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1048.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1058.9. Examples of logs
106
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001079. Supported filters
1089.1. Trace
1099.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001109.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001119.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200112
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011310. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011410.1. Limitation
11510.2. Setup
11610.2.1. Cache section
11710.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200118
1191. Quick reminder about HTTP
120----------------------------
121
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100122When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
124on almost anything found in the contents.
125
126However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
127formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
128correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
129
130
1311.1. The HTTP transaction model
132-------------------------------
133
134The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100135to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100136from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
137connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138will involve a new connection :
139
140 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
141
142In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
143establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
144by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
145length.
146
147Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
148to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
149however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
150response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
151header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
152
153 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
154
155Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
156power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
157but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200158a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100160Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
162second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
163page :
164
165 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
166
167This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
168latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
169correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
170the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100171server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
174time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
175are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
176parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
177carry the stream identifier.
178
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100179By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
180connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
181leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100182start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
183processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
184waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200185
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200186HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100187 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
188 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100189 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200191 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100193For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
194the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
196is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
197servers.
198
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199
2001.2. HTTP request
201-----------------
202
203First, let's consider this HTTP request :
204
205 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100206 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
208 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
209 3 User-agent: my small browser
210 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
211 5 Accept: image/png
212
213
2141.2.1. The Request line
215-----------------------
216
217Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
218
219 - a METHOD : GET
220 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
222
223All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
224which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
225followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
226is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
227desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
228the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
229
230The URI itself can have several forms :
231
232 - A "relative URI" :
233
234 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235
236 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
237 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
238
239 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
240
241 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242
243 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
244 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
245 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
246 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
247 must accept this form too.
248
249 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
250 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
251 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200253 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
254 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
255 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
256 other protocols too.
257
258In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
259mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
260on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
261It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
262specific to the language, framework or application in use.
263
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100264HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100265assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100266However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
267received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
268processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
269as well as in server logs.
270
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200271
2721.2.2. The request headers
273--------------------------
274
275The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
276beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
277an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
278Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
279values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
280encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
281the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
282define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
283
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100284Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
287as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
289The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
290that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
291is one valid form of empty line.
292
293Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
294headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
295about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
296application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
297
298Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000299 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
301 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
302 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
303
304
3051.3. HTTP response
306------------------
307
308An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
309messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
310
311 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100312 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
314 2 Content-length: 350
315 3 Content-Type: text/html
316
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200317As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
318codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
319response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100320continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
321the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
322following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
323sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
324(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
325correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
326such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
327state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
328over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
329if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
330information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003331.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200334------------------------
335
336Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
337
338 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
339 - a status code : 200
340 - a reason : OK
341
342The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100343 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
344 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
345 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
346 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
347 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200348
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000349Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100350"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
352messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
353or "Authentication Required".
354
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200356
357 Code When / reason
358 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
359 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
361 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100362 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
363 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364 400 for an invalid or too large request
365 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
366 accessing the stats page)
367 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
368 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
369 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
370 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
371 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
372 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
373 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
374 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
375 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
376
377The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3784.2).
379
380
3811.3.2. The response headers
382---------------------------
383
384Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
385the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
386details.
387
388
3892. Configuring HAProxy
390----------------------
391
3922.1. Configuration file format
393------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200394
395HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
396
397 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
398 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
399 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
400 "frontend" and "backend".
401
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100402The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
403referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200404delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200406
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004072.2. Quoting and escaping
408-------------------------
409
410HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
411many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
412with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
413single quotes.
414
415If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
416them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
417escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
418
419Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
420
421 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
422 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
423 \\ to use a backslash
424 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
425 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
426
427Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
428the interpretation of:
429
430 space as a parameter separator
431 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
432 # hash as a comment start
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200434Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
435-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
436backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
437
438Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200439quoting.
440
441Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
442nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
443
444Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
445equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
446
447 Example:
448 # those are equivalents:
449 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
450 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
451 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
453 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
454
455 # those are equivalents:
456 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
459 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
460
461
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004622.3. Environment variables
463--------------------------
464
465HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
466interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
467configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
468optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
469shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
470underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
471
472 Example:
473
474 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
475
476 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
477
478 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
479
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200480Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
481file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200482
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200483* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
484 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
485
486* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
487 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
488 directory.
489
490* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
491
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500492* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200493 processes, separated by semicolons.
494
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500495* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200496 CLI, separated by semicolons.
497
498See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200499
5002.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200501----------------
502
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100503Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100504values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
505otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
506numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
507for every keyword. Supported units are :
508
509 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
510 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
511 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
512 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
513 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
514 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
515
516
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005172.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200518-------------
519
520 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
521 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
522 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
523 global
524 daemon
525 maxconn 256
526
527 defaults
528 mode http
529 timeout connect 5000ms
530 timeout client 50000ms
531 timeout server 50000ms
532
533 frontend http-in
534 bind *:80
535 default_backend servers
536
537 backend servers
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
542 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
543 global
544 daemon
545 maxconn 256
546
547 defaults
548 mode http
549 timeout connect 5000ms
550 timeout client 50000ms
551 timeout server 50000ms
552
553 listen http-in
554 bind *:80
555 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
556
557
558Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
559
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100560 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200561
562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005633. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200564--------------------
565
566Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
567are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
568of them have command-line equivalents.
569
570The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
571
572 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200573 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200575 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200578 - description
579 - deviceatlas-json-file
580 - deviceatlas-log-level
581 - deviceatlas-separator
582 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900583 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - gid
585 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100586 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200588 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100589 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - lua-load
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200591 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200592 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200593 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200594 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200595 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100596 - presetenv
597 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - uid
599 - ulimit-n
600 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200601 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100602 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200603 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200604 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200605 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200606 - ssl-default-bind-options
607 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200608 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - ssl-default-server-options
610 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100611 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100612 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100613 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100614 - 51degrees-data-file
615 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200616 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200617 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200618 - wurfl-data-file
619 - wurfl-information-list
620 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200621 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100622
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200623 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200624 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200625 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200626 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100627 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100628 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100629 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200630 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200631 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200632 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200633 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 - noepoll
635 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000636 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100638 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300639 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000640 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100641 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200642 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200643 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200644 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000645 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000646 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200647 - tune.buffers.limit
648 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200649 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200650 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100651 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200652 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200653 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200654 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100655 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200656 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200657 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100658 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100659 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100660 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100661 - tune.lua.session-timeout
662 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200663 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100664 - tune.maxaccept
665 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200667 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200668 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100669 - tune.rcvbuf.client
670 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100671 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200672 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100673 - tune.sndbuf.client
674 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100675 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100676 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200677 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100678 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200679 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200680 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100681 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200682 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100683 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200684 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
685 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
686 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100687 - tune.zlib.memlevel
688 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100689
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200690 * Debugging
691 - debug
692 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200693
694
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006953.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200696------------------------------------
697
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200698ca-base <dir>
699 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200700 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
701 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200702
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200703chroot <jail dir>
704 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
705 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
706 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
707 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
708 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100709 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100710
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100711cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
712 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
713 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
714 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
715 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
716 set. These sets have the format
717
718 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
719
720 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100721 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
723 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100724 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
725 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100726 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100727 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100728 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100729 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
731 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
732 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
733 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100735 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
736 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
737 on the machine's word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
741 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
742 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
743 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
744 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
745 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100746
747 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100748 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
749
750 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
751 # first 4 CPUs
752
753 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
754 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
755 # word size.
756
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100757 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100759 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
760 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
761 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
762
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100763 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
764 # and so on.
765 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
766 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
767 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
768
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100769 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100770 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
771 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
772 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
773
774 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
775 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
776 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
777
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
779 # and a thread range.
780 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
781 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
782 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
783
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200784crt-base <dir>
785 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
786 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
787 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
788
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200789daemon
790 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
791 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100792 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
793 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200795deviceatlas-json-file <path>
796 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100797 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200798
799deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100800 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200801 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
802
803deviceatlas-separator <char>
804 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
805 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
806
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100807deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200808 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
809 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
810 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100811
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900812external-check
813 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
814 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
815 See "option external-check".
816
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200817gid <number>
818 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
819 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
820 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100821 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
822 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100824
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100825hard-stop-after <time>
826 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
827
828 Arguments :
829 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
830 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
831 SIGUSR1 signal.
832
833 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
834 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
835 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
836
837 Example:
838 global
839 hard-stop-after 30s
840
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200841group <group name>
842 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
843 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100844
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200845log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
846 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100847 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100848 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100849 configured with "log global".
850
851 <address> can be one of:
852
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100853 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100854 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
855 port).
856
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100857 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
858 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
859 port).
860
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100861 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100862 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
863 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100864 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100865
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100866 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
867 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
868 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
869 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
870 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
871 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
872 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
873 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
874 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
875 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
876 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
877 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
878 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
879 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100880 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
881 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100882
883 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
884 "fd@2", see above.
885
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200886 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
887 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100888
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200889 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
890 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
891 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
892 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
893 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
894 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
895 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
896 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
897 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
898 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100899 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
900 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200901
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200902 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
903 one of the following :
904
905 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
906 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
907
908 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
909 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
910
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100911 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
912 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
913 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
914 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
915 logger consumes.
916
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100917 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
918 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
919 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
920 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
921
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200922 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
923 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
924 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
925 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
926 set with <sample_size> parameter.
927
928 <sample_size>
929 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
930 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
931 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
932 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
933 (see also <ranges> parameter).
934
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100935 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100937 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
938 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
939 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100941 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
942 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
943 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
944 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200945
946 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200947 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
948 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
949 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
950 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
951 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
952 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200954 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100956log-send-hostname [<string>]
957 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
958 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
959 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
960 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
961 the logs.
962
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000963log-tag <string>
964 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
965 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
966 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100967 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000968
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100969lua-load <file>
970 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
971 used multiple times.
972
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100973master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200974 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
975 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
976 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100977 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200978 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
979 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100980 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
981 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
982 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
983 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
984 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200985
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100986 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200987
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200988mworker-max-reloads <number>
989 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500990 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200991 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
992 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
993 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995nbproc <number>
996 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
997 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
998 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +0100999 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1000 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001001 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1002 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001003
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001004nbthread <number>
1005 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001006 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1007 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1008 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1009 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1010 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001011 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1012 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1013 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1014 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1015 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1016 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1017 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001018
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001019pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001020 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001021 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1022 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1023
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024presetenv <name> <value>
1025 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1026 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1027 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1028 and "unsetenv".
1029
1030resetenv [<name> ...]
1031 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1032 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1033 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1034 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1035 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1036 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1037 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1038 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1039
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001040stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001041 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1042 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1043 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1044 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1045 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1046 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001047 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001048 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1049 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1050 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1051 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001052
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001053server-state-base <directory>
1054 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001055 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1056 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001057
1058server-state-file <file>
1059 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1060 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1061 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1062 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1063 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1064 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1065 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1066 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001067 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1068 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001069
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070setenv <name> <value>
1071 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1072 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1073 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1074 and "unsetenv".
1075
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001076set-dumpable
1077 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
1078 developer's request. It has no impact on performance nor stability but will
1079 try hard to re-enable core dumps that were possibly disabled by file size
1080 limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations (ulimit -c), or "dumpability"
1081 of a process after changing its UID/GID (such as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable
1082 on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by the current directory's
1083 permissions (check what directory the file is started from), the chroot
1084 directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily disable the chroot
1085 directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location), or any other
1086 system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are notorious
1087 for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable not even
1088 installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often, simply
1089 writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the issue.
1090 When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to re-appear, it's
1091 often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by issuing, for example,
1092 "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it leaves a core where
1093 expected when dying.
1094
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001095ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1097 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001098 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001099 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001100 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1101 information and recommendations see e.g.
1102 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1103 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1104 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1105 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001106
1107ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1108 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1109 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1110 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1111 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1112 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001113 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1114 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1115 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001116 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001117
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001118ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1120 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1121 keyword to see available options.
1122
1123 Example:
1124 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001125 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001126
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001127ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1128 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1129 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001130 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001131 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001132 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1133 information and recommendations see e.g.
1134 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1135 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1136 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1137 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1138 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001139
1140ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1142 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1143 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1144 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1145 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001146 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1147 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1148 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1149 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001150
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001151ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1153 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1154 keyword to see available options.
1155
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001156ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1158 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1159 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001160 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001161 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001162 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1163 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1164 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1165 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001166 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1167 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1168 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1169
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001170ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1171 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1172 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1173 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1174
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001175stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1176 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1177 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1178 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001179 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001180 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001181
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001182 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1183 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1184 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001185
1186stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1187 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1188 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001189 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001190
1191stats maxconn <connections>
1192 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1193 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1194
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001195uid <number>
1196 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1197 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1198 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1199 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1200
1201ulimit-n <number>
1202 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1203 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1204 option.
1205
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001206unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1207 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1208
1209 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1210 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1211 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1212 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1213 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1214 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1215 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1216 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1217 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1218 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1219
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001220unsetenv [<name> ...]
1221 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1222 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1223 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1224 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1225 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1226 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1227 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1228
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001229user <user name>
1230 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1231 See also "uid" and "group".
1232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001233node <name>
1234 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1235
1236 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1237 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1238 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1239 traffic.
1240
1241description <text>
1242 Add a text that describes the instance.
1243
1244 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1245 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1246 "<" and ">" characters.
1247
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100124851degrees-data-file <file path>
1249 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001250 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001251
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001252 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001253 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1254
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000125551degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001256 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1257 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1258 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1259
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001260 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001261 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1262
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200126351degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001264 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1265 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1266
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001267 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1268 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1269
127051degrees-cache-size <number>
1271 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1272 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1273 By default, this cache is disabled.
1274
1275 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001276 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1277
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001278wurfl-data-file <file path>
1279 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1280 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1281
1282 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1283 with USE_WURFL=1.
1284
1285wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1286 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1287 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1288 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1289
1290 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1291
1292 Valid WURFL properties are:
1293 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1294
1295 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1296 device.
1297
1298 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1299 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1300
1301 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1302 particular web request.
1303
1304 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1305 used Libwurfl API version.
1306
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001307 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1308 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1309
1310 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1311 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1312
1313 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1314
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001315 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1316 with USE_WURFL=1.
1317
1318wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1319 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1320 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1321
1322 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1323 with USE_WURFL=1.
1324
1325wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1326 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1327 thus before the chroot.
1328
1329 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1330 with USE_WURFL=1.
1331
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001332wurfl-cache-size <size>
1333 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1334 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001335 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001336 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001337
1338 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1339 with USE_WURFL=1.
1340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013413.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001342-----------------------
1343
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001344busy-polling
1345 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1346 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1347 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1348 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1349 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1350 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1351 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1352 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1353 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1354 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1355 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1356 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1357 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1358 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1359 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1360 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1361 "poll" pollers.
1362
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001363max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1364 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1365 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1366 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1367 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1368 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1369 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1370 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1371 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001373maxconn <number>
1374 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1375 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1376 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001377 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1378 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1379 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1380 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001381 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1382 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1383 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1384 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1385 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1386 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001387
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001388maxconnrate <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1390 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1391 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1392 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1393 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1394 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1395 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1396 fairness.
1397
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001398maxcomprate <number>
1399 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001400 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001401 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1402 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1403 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001404 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001405 default value.
1406
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001407maxcompcpuusage <number>
1408 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1409 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1410 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1411 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1412 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1413 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1414 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1415 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1416
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001417maxpipes <number>
1418 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1419 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1420 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1421 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1422 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1423 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1424
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001425maxsessrate <number>
1426 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1427 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1428 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1429 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1430 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1431 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1432 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1433 fairness.
1434
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001435maxsslconn <number>
1436 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1437 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1438 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1439 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1440 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1441 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1442 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001443 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1444 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1445 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1446 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1447 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1448 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1449 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001450
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001451maxsslrate <number>
1452 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1453 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1454 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1455 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1456 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1457 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1458 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1459 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1460 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1461 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1462
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001463maxzlibmem <number>
1464 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1465 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1466 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001467 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1468 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1469 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1470
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001471noepoll
1472 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1473 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001474 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001475
1476nokqueue
1477 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1478 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1479 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1480
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001481noevports
1482 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1483 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1484 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1485 also "nopoll".
1486
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001487nopoll
1488 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1489 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001490 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001491 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1492 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001493
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001494nosplice
1495 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001496 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001497 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001498 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001499 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1500 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1501 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1502 "option splice-response".
1503
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001504nogetaddrinfo
1505 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1506 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1507
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001508noreuseport
1509 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1510 command line argument "-dR".
1511
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001512profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1513 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1514 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1515 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1516 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001517 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001518 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1519 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1520 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1521 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1522
1523 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1524 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1525 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1526 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1527 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001528 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1529 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1530 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1531 CLI.
1532
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001533spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001534 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1535 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1536 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1537 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1538 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1539 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001540
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001541ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001542 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001543 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001544 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1545 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1546 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1547 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1548 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001549 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1550 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001551 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1552 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1553 openssl configuration file uses:
1554 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1555
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001556ssl-mode-async
1557 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001558 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001559 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1560 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1561 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001562 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001563 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001564
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001565tune.buffers.limit <number>
1566 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1567 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1568 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1569 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1570 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001571 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001572 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1573 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1574 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1575 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1576 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1577 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1578 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1579 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1580 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1581
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001582tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1583 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1584 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1585 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1586 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1587
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001588tune.bufsize <number>
1589 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1590 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1591 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1592 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1593 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1594 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1595 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001596 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1597 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1598 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001599 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001600 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1601 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1602 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001603
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001604tune.chksize <number>
1605 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1606 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1607 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1608 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1609 checks whenever possible.
1610
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001611tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1612 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1613 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1614 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1615 this value. The default value is 1.
1616
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001617tune.fail-alloc
1618 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1619 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1620 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1621 gracefully.
1622
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001623tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1624 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1625 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1626 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1627 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1628 change it.
1629
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001630tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1631 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001632 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1633 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001634 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1635 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1636 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1637 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1638 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1639
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001640tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1641 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1642 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1643 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1644 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1645 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1646 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1647 recommended not to change this value.
1648
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001649tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1650 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1651 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1652 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1653 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1654 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1655 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1656 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1657
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001658tune.http.cookielen <number>
1659 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1660 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1661 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1662 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1663 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1664 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1665 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1666 to change this value.
1667
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001668tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001669 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1670 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001671 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001672 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001673 configuration directives too.
1674 The default value is 1024.
1675
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001676tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1677 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1678 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1679 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1680 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1681 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1682 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001683 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1684 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1685 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001686
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001687tune.idletimer <timeout>
1688 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1689 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1690 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1691 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1692 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1693 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001694 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001695 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001696 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1697
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001698tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1699 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1700 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1701 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1702 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1703 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1704 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1705 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1706 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1707 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1708
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001709tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1710 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001711 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001712 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1713 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001714 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001715 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1716 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1717
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001718tune.lua.maxmem
1719 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1720 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1721 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1722 memory.
1723
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001724tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1725 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001726 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1727 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001728 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001729
1730tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1731 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1732 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1733 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1734 check servers.
1735
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001736tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1737 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1738 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1739 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001741
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001742tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001743 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1744 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1745 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1746 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1747 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1748 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1749 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1750 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1751 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1752 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001753
1754tune.maxpollevents <number>
1755 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1756 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1757 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1758 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1759 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1760
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001761tune.maxrewrite <number>
1762 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1763 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1764 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1765 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1766 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1767 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1768 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1769 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1770 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1771 bufsize.
1772
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001773tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1774 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1775 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1776 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1777 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1778 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1779 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1780 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1781 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1782 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1783 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1784 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1785 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1786 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1787 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1788 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1789 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1790 setting this parameter to 0.
1791
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001792tune.pipesize <number>
1793 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1794 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1795 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1796 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1797 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1798 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1799
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001800tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
1801 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1802 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1803 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
1804 default is 20.
1805
1806tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
1807 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
1808 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
1809 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
1810 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
1811 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
1812 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001813 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02001814
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001815tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1816tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1817 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1818 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1819 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001820 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001821 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001822 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1823 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1824
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001825tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001826 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001827 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1828 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1829 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1830 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1831
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001832tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001833 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001834 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1835 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1836
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001837tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1838tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1839 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1840 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1841 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001842 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001843 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001844 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1845 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1846 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1847 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1848 notifying haproxy again.
1849
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001850tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001851 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1852 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1853 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001854 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001855 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001856 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001857 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1858 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1859 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001860 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1861 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001862
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001863tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001864 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001865 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1866 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1867 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1868 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1869 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1870
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001871tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1872 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001873 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001874 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1875 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1876 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1877 being used for too long.
1878
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001879tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1880 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1881 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1882 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1883 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1884 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1885 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1886 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1887 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1888 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1889 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001890 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001891 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001892
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001893tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1894 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1895 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1896 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1897 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1898 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1899 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1900 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001901 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1902 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001903
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001904tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1905 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1906 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1907 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1908 1000 entries.
1909
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001910tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1911 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1912 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1913 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1914
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001915tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001916tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001917tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1918tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1919tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001920 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1921 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1922 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1923 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1924 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1925 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1926 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1927 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001928
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001929 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1930 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1931 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1932 all available space is consumed.
1933 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1934 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1935 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001936
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001937tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1938 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001939 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001940 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001941 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001942 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1943
1944tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1945 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1946 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001947 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1948 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019503.3. Debugging
1951--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001952
1953debug
1954 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1955 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1956 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1957 system startup.
1958
1959quiet
1960 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1961 line argument "-q".
1962
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019643.4. Userlists
1965--------------
1966It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1967http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1968it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1969
1970userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001971 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001972 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1973
1974group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001975 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001976 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1977 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1978
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001979user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1980 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001981 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1982 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001983 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1984 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1985 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1986 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001987
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001988 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1989 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1990 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1991 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1992 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1993 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1994 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1995 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1996 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001997
1998 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001999 userlist L1
2000 group G1 users tiger,scott
2001 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002002
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002003 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2004 user scott insecure-password elgato
2005 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002006
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002007 userlist L2
2008 group G1
2009 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002010
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002011 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2012 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2013 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002014
2015 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002017
20183.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002019----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002020It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2021several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2022instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2023values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2024automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2025In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2026using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2027tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2028reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2029Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2030that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2031each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002032
2033peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002034 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002035 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2036
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002037bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2038 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2039 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2040
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002041disabled
2042 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2043 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2044 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2045
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002046default-bind [param*]
2047 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2048
2049default-server [param*]
2050 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2051
2052 Arguments:
2053 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2054 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2055 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2056 details.
2057
2058
2059 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2060
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002061enable
2062 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2063
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002064peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002065 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2066 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2067 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2068 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2069 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2070 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2071
2072 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2073 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2074
2075 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2076 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2077 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2078 across all peers.
2079
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002080 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2081 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002082
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002083 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2084 "server" keyword explanation below).
2085
2086server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002087 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002088 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2089 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2090 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2091 of this "peers" section).
2092 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2093
2094
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002095 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002096 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002097 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002098 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2099 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2100 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002101
2102 backend mybackend
2103 mode tcp
2104 balance roundrobin
2105 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2106 stick on src
2107
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002108 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2109 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002110
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002111 Example:
2112 peers mypeers
2113 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2114 default-server ssl verify none
2115 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2116 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002117
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002118
2119table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2120 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2121
2122 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2123 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002124 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002125 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2126 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2127 "stick-table" keyword).
2128
2129 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2130 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2131 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2132 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2133 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2134 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2135 of the stick-table name as follows:
2136
2137 peers mypeers
2138 peer A ...
2139 peer B ...
2140 table t1 ...
2141
2142 frontend fe1
2143 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2144
2145 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2146 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2147
2148 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2149 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2150 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2151 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2152 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2153 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2154 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2155
2156 peers mypeers
2157 peer A ...
2158 peer B ...
2159 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2160
2161 backend t1
2162 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2163
2164 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2165 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2166 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2167
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090021683.6. Mailers
2169------------
2170It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2171If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2172in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2173
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002174mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002175 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2176 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2177
2178mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2179 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2180
2181 Example:
2182 mailers mymailers
2183 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2184 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2185
2186 backend mybackend
2187 mode tcp
2188 balance roundrobin
2189
2190 email-alert mailers mymailers
2191 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2192 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2193
2194 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2195 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2196
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002197timeout mail <time>
2198 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2199 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2200 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2201 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2202
2203 Example:
2204 mailers mymailers
2205 timeout mail 20s
2206 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002207
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020022083.7. Programs
2209-------------
2210In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2211master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2212managed the same way as the workers.
2213
2214During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2215sequence as a worker:
2216
2217 - the master is re-executed
2218 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2219 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2220 instance of the program
2221
2222During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2223
2224program <name>
2225 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2226 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2227 the management guide).
2228
2229command <command> [arguments*]
2230 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2231 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2232 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2233 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2234
2235option start-on-reload
2236no option start-on-reload
2237 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2238 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2239 program section.
2240
2241
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022424. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002243----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002244
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002245Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002246 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002247 - frontend <name>
2248 - backend <name>
2249 - listen <name>
2250
2251A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2252its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2253section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002254section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002255
2256A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2257connections.
2258
2259A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2260to forward incoming connections.
2261
2262A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2263parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2264
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002265All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2266'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2267case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2268
2269Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2270logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2271proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2272However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2273name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2274
2275Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2276and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002277bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2279modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2280arbitrary criteria.
2281
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002282In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2283a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002284the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002285
2286 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2287 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2288 between responses and new requests.
2289
2290 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2291 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2292 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002293 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
2294 And because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it is
2295 only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
2296 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002297
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002298 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2299 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2300 client-facing connection remains open.
2301
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002302 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2303 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002304
2305The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2306frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2307following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002308weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002309
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002310 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002311
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002312 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2313 ----+-----+-----+----
2314 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2315 ----+-----+-----+----
2316 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2317 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2318 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2319 ----+-----+-----+----
2320 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002322
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002323
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023244.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2325--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002327The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2328limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2329they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2330limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002331marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002332option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002333and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2334with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2335specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002338 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2339------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2340acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002341backlog X X X -
2342balance X - X X
2343bind - X X -
2344bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002345block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002346capture cookie - X X -
2347capture request header - X X -
2348capture response header - X X -
2349clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002350compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002351contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2352cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002353declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002354default-server X - X X
2355default_backend X X X -
2356description - X X X
2357disabled X X X X
2358dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002359email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002360email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002361email-alert mailers X X X X
2362email-alert myhostname X X X X
2363email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002364enabled X X X X
2365errorfile X X X X
2366errorloc X X X X
2367errorloc302 X X X X
2368-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2369errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002370force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002371filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002372fullconn X - X X
2373grace X X X X
2374hash-type X - X X
2375http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002376http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002377http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002378http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002379http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002380http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002381http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002382id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002383ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002384load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002385log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002386log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002387log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002388log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002389max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002390maxconn X X X -
2391mode X X X X
2392monitor fail - X X -
2393monitor-net X X X -
2394monitor-uri X X X -
2395option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2396option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2397option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2398option allbackups (*) X - X X
2399option checkcache (*) X - X X
2400option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2401option contstats (*) X X X -
2402option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2403option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002404-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2405option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002406option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002407option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002408option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002409option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002410option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002411option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01002412option http-tunnel (deprecated) (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002413option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002414option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002415option httpchk X - X X
2416option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002417option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002418option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002419option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002420option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002421option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002422option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2423option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2424option logasap (*) X X X -
2425option mysql-check X - X X
2426option nolinger (*) X X X X
2427option originalto X X X X
2428option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002429option pgsql-check X - X X
2430option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002431option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002432option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002433option smtpchk X - X X
2434option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2435option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2436option splice-request (*) X X X X
2437option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002438option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002439option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2440option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2441-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002442option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002443option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2444option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2445option tcpka X X X X
2446option tcplog X X X X
2447option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002448external-check command X - X X
2449external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002450persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2451rate-limit sessions X X X -
2452redirect - X X X
2453redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2454redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002455reqadd (deprecated) - X X X
2456reqallow (deprecated) - X X X
2457reqdel (deprecated) - X X X
2458reqdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2459reqiallow (deprecated) - X X X
2460reqidel (deprecated) - X X X
2461reqideny (deprecated) - X X X
2462reqipass (deprecated) - X X X
2463reqirep (deprecated) - X X X
2464reqitarpit (deprecated) - X X X
2465reqpass (deprecated) - X X X
2466reqrep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002467-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002468reqtarpit (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002469retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002470retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02002471rspadd (deprecated) - X X X
2472rspdel (deprecated) - X X X
2473rspdeny (deprecated) - X X X
2474rspidel (deprecated) - X X X
2475rspideny (deprecated) - X X X
2476rspirep (deprecated) - X X X
2477rsprep (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002478server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002479server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002480server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002481source X - X X
2482srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002483stats admin - X X X
2484stats auth X X X X
2485stats enable X X X X
2486stats hide-version X X X X
2487stats http-request - X X X
2488stats realm X X X X
2489stats refresh X X X X
2490stats scope X X X X
2491stats show-desc X X X X
2492stats show-legends X X X X
2493stats show-node X X X X
2494stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002495-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2496stick match - - X X
2497stick on - - X X
2498stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002499stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002500stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002501tcp-check connect - - X X
2502tcp-check expect - - X X
2503tcp-check send - - X X
2504tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002505tcp-request connection - X X -
2506tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002507tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002508tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002509tcp-response content - - X X
2510tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002511timeout check X - X X
2512timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002513timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002514timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2515timeout connect X - X X
2516timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2517timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2518timeout http-request X X X X
2519timeout queue X - X X
2520timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002521timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002522timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2523timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002524timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002525transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002526unique-id-format X X X -
2527unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002528use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002529use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002530------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2531 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002532
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025344.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2535---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002536
2537This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2538
2539
2540acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2541 Declare or complete an access list.
2542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 no | yes | yes | yes
2544 Example:
2545 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2546 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2547 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2548
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002549 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550
2551
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002552backlog <conns>
2553 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2555 yes | yes | yes | no
2556 Arguments :
2557 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2558 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002559 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002560
2561 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2562 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2563 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2564 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2565 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2566 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2567 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2568 backlog parameter.
2569
2570 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2571 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2572 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2573
2574 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2575
2576
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002577balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002578balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002579 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2581 yes | no | yes | yes
2582 Arguments :
2583 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2584 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2585 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2586 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2587
2588 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2589 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2590 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2591 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002592 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002593 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002594 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2595 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2596 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2597 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2598 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2599 it, so that you don't worry.
2600
2601 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2602 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2603 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2604 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2605 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2606 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2607 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2608 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002610 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2611 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2612 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2613 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2614 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2615 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2616 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2617 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2618
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002619 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002620 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002621 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2622 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002623 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002624 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2625 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2626 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2627 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2628 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002629 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2630 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2631 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2632 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2633 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2634 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002635
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002636 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2637 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2638 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2639 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2640 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2641 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2642 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2643 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002644 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002646 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2647 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2648 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002650 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2651 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2652 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2653 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2654 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2655 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2656 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2657 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2658 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2659 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2660 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2661 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002662
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002663 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002664 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2665 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2666 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2667 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2668 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2669 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2670 URIs start with a leading "/".
2671
2672 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2673 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2674 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2675 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002678 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2679
2680 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002681 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2682 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002683 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2684 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2685 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2686 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002687 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002688 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2689 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002690
2691 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2692 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2693 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2694 server will receive the request.
2695
2696 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2697 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2698 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2699 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2700 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002701 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2702 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2703 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002704
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002705 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2706 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2707 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2708 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2709 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002710
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002711 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002712 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2713 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2714 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2715
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002716 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2717 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2718 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2719
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002720 random
2721 random(<draws>)
2722 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002723 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2724 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2725 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2726 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002727 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2728 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2729 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2730 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2731 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2732 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2733 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2734 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2735 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2736 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2737 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2738 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2739 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2740 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2741 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2742 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2743 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2744 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2745 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2746 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002747
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002748 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002749 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002750 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2751 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2752 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2753 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2754 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2755 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002756 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002757 used instead.
2758
2759 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2760 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2761 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2762 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2763
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002764 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2765 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2766 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2767
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002768 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002769
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002770 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002771 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2772 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002773
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002774 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2775 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2776 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002777
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002778 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002779 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002780 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2781 NTLM relies on.
2782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002783 Examples :
2784 balance roundrobin
2785 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002786 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002787 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2788 balance hdr(host)
2789 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002790
2791 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2792 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002794 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002795 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2796 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2797 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2798 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2799
2800 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2801 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2802 defaults to 16 kB.
2803
2804 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2805 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2806
2807 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2808 Round Robin.
2809
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002810 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002811 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2812 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2813 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2814
2815 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2816
2817 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002818 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002819 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2820 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2821 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002822
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002823 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002824
2825
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002826bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2827bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2830 no | yes | yes | no
2831 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002832 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2833 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2834 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2835 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002836 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002837 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2838 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2839 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2840 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2841 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2842 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2843 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002844 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2845 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2846 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2847 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2848 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2849 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2850 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002851 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2852 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2853 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002854 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2855 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2856 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2857 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002858 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2859 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2860 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002861
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002862 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2863 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002864 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2865 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2866 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002867 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2868 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2869 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2870 the range.
2871
2872 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2873 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2874 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2875 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2876 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2877 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2878 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002879 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002880 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002882 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002883 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002884 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2885 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2886 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2887 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2888 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2889 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2890
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002891 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2892 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2893 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2894 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2897 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2898 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2899 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2900 in a frontend.
2901
2902 Example :
2903 listen http_proxy
2904 bind :80,:443
2905 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002906 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002907
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002908 listen http_https_proxy
2909 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002910 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002911
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002912 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2913 bind ipv6@:80
2914 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2915 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2916
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002917 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002918 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002919
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002920 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2921 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2922 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2923 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2924 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2925
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002926 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002927 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002928
2929
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002930bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002931 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2933 yes | yes | yes | yes
2934 Arguments :
2935 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2936 may be used to override a default value.
2937
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002938 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002939 option may be combined with other numbers.
2940
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002941 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002942 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2943 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2944 missing from all processes.
2945
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002946 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002947 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002948 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2949 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2950 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2951 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2952 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002953 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002954
2955 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2956 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2957 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2958 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2959 and 'even' instances.
2960
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002961 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2962 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2963 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2964 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002965
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002966 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2967 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2968
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002969 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2970 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2971 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2972
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002973 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2974 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2975
2976 Example :
2977 listen app_ip1
2978 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002979 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002980
2981 listen app_ip2
2982 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002983 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002984
2985 listen management
2986 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002987 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002988
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002989 listen management
2990 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2991 bind-process 1-4
2992
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002993 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002994
2995
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002996block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2999 no | yes | yes | yes
3000
3001 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
3002 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003003 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003004 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003005 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003006 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
3007 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
3008 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02003010 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
3011 "http-request deny" instead.
3012
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003013 Example:
3014 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3015 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3016 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03003017 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
3018 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
3019 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003020
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03003021 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
3022 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
3023 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024
3025capture cookie <name> len <length>
3026 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3028 no | yes | yes | no
3029 Arguments :
3030 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3031 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3032 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3033 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003034 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
3036 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3037 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3038 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3039 right if it exceeds <length>.
3040
3041 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3042 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3043 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3044 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3045
3046 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3047 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3048 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3049
3050 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3051 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3052 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003053 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3054 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3055 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003056
3057 Example:
3058 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3059
3060 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003061 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062
3063
3064capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003065 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3067 no | yes | yes | no
3068 Arguments :
3069 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003070 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3072 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3073 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3074
3075 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3076 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3077 it exceeds <length>.
3078
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003079 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003080 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3081 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003082 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3083 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3084 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3085 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003086 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003087 environments to find where the request came from.
3088
3089 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3090 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3091 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3092 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003093
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003094 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3095 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3096 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3097 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3098 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003099
3100 Example:
3101 capture request header Host len 15
3102 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003103 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003104
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003105 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 about logging.
3107
3108
3109capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003110 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3112 no | yes | yes | no
3113 Arguments :
3114 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003115 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3117 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3118 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3119
3120 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3121 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3122 it exceeds <length>.
3123
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003124 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3126 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3127 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003128 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3129 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3130 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3131 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003133 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3134 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3135 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3136 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3137 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003138
3139 Example:
3140 capture response header Content-length len 9
3141 capture response header Location len 15
3142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003143 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003144 about logging.
3145
3146
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003147clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3150 yes | yes | yes | no
3151 Arguments :
3152 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3153 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3154 as explained at the top of this document.
3155
3156 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3157 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3158 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3159 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3160 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3161 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3162 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3163 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003164 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003166 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003167
3168 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3169 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3170 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3171 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3172 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3173 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3174
3175 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3176 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3177
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003178 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3179 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003181compression algo <algorithm> ...
3182compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003183compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003184 Enable HTTP compression.
3185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3186 yes | yes | yes | yes
3187 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003188 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3189 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3190 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3191
3192 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003193 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3194 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3195 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003196
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003197 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003198 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003199
3200 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3201 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3202 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3203 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3204 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003205 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003206
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003207 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3208 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3209 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3210 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3211 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3212 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3213 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003214 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003215
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003216 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003217 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003218 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3219 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3220 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3221 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3222 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003223
3224 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3225 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3226 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3227 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3228 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003229 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3230 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3231 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3232 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3233 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003234 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3235 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003236
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003237 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003238 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3239 "Accept-Encoding" header
3240 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003241 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003242 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3243 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3244 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3245 "multipart"
3246 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3247 header
3248 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3249 and later
3250 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3251 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003252 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003253
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003254 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003255
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003256 Examples :
3257 compression algo gzip
3258 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003260
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003261contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003262 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3264 yes | no | yes | yes
3265 Arguments :
3266 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3267 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3268 as explained at the top of this document.
3269
3270 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003271 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003272 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003273 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003274 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3275 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3276 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3277
3278 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3279 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3280 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3281 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3282 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3283 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3284
3285 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3286 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3287 instead.
3288
3289 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3290 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3291
3292
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003293cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003294 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3295 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003296 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003297 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3299 yes | no | yes | yes
3300 Arguments :
3301 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3302 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3303 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3304 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3305 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3306 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003307 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003308 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3309 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3310
3311 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3312 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3313 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3314 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3315 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3316 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003317 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3318 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003319 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003320 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3321 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003322
3323 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003324 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003325
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003326 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003327 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003328 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003329 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003330 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3331 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3332 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3333 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3334 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3335 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3336 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003337
3338 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3339 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3340 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3341 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3342 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3343 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3344 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3345 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3346 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003347 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003348 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3349 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3350 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003351
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003352 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3353 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3354 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003355 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3356 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3357 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3358 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003359 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3360 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3361 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003362
3363 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3364 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3365 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3366 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3367 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3368 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3369 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3370 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3371 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3372
3373 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3374 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3375 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3376 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3377 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3378 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3379 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3380 persistence cookie in the cache.
3381 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3382
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003383 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3384 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3385 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3386 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3387 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003388 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003389 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3390 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3391 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3392 they logout.
3393
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003394 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3395 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3396 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3397 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3398
3399 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3400 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3401 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3402 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3403 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3404 this attribute.
3405
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003406 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003407 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003408 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3409 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3410 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3411 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3412 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3413 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003414
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003415 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3416 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3417 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3418 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3419 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3420 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3421 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3422 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003423 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003424 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3425 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3426 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3427 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3428 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3429 the site.
3430
3431 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3432 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3433 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3434 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3435 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3436 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3437 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3438 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3439 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3440 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3441 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3442 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3443 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003444 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003445 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3446 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3447
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003448 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3449 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3450 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3451 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3452 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3453 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3454
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3456 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3457 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3458 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460 Examples :
3461 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3462 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3463 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003464 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003466 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003467
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003468
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003469declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3470 Declares a capture slot.
3471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3472 no | yes | yes | no
3473 Arguments:
3474 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3475
3476 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3477 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3478 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3479 for use in the response.
3480
3481 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003482 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003483 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3484
3485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003486default-server [param*]
3487 Change default options for a server in a backend
3488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3489 yes | no | yes | yes
3490 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003491 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3492 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3493 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3494 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003495
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003496 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003497 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3498
3499 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502default_backend <backend>
3503 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3505 yes | yes | yes | no
3506 Arguments :
3507 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3508
3509 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3510 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3511 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3512 will catch all undetermined requests.
3513
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514 Example :
3515
3516 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3517 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3518 default_backend dynamic
3519
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003520 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003521
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003523description <string>
3524 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3525 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3526 no | yes | yes | yes
3527 Arguments : string
3528
3529 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3530 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3531 it describes.
3532 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3533
3534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003535disabled
3536 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3538 yes | yes | yes | yes
3539 Arguments : none
3540
3541 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3542 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3543 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3544 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3545 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3546 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3547 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3548
3549 See also : "enabled"
3550
3551
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003552dispatch <address>:<port>
3553 Set a default server address
3554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3555 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003557
3558 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3559 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3560 during start-up.
3561
3562 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3563 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3564 possible with normal servers.
3565
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003566 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003567 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3568 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3569 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3570 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3571
3572 See also : "server"
3573
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003574
3575dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3576 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 yes | no | yes | yes
3579 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3580
3581 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003582 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003583 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3584 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003585 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003586 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003588enabled
3589 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3590 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3591 yes | yes | yes | yes
3592 Arguments : none
3593
3594 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3595 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3596
3597 See also : "disabled"
3598
3599
3600errorfile <code> <file>
3601 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3603 yes | yes | yes | yes
3604 Arguments :
3605 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003606 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3607 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003608
3609 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003610 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003611 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003612 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3613 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003614
3615 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3616 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3617 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3618
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003619 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3620
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3622 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3623 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3624 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3625
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003626 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3627 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003628 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003629 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3630 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3631 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3632
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003633 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3634 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3635 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003636 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003637 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3638
3639 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3640
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003641 Example :
3642 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003643 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003644 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3645 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3646
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003647
3648errorloc <code> <url>
3649errorloc302 <code> <url>
3650 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3652 yes | yes | yes | yes
3653 Arguments :
3654 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003655 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3656 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003657
3658 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3659 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3660 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3661 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003662 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003663
3664 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3665 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3666 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3667
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003668 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003670 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3671 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3672 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3673 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003674 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003675 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3676 request.
3677
3678 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3679
3680
3681errorloc303 <code> <url>
3682 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3684 yes | yes | yes | yes
3685 Arguments :
3686 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003687 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3688 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003689
3690 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3691 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3692 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3693 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003694 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
3696 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3697 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3698 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3699
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003700 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003702 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3703 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3704 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3705 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003706 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003707
3708 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3709
3710
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003711email-alert from <emailaddr>
3712 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003713 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003714 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3715 yes | yes | yes | yes
3716
3717 Arguments :
3718
3719 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3720
3721 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3722 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3723
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003724 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003725 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3726 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003727
3728
3729email-alert level <level>
3730 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3731 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3732 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3733 yes | yes | yes | yes
3734
3735 Arguments :
3736
3737 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3738 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3739 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3740
3741 By default level is alert
3742
3743 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3744 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3745 for the proxy.
3746
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003747 Alerts are sent when :
3748
3749 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3750 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3751 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3752 is notice or lower
3753 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3754 and a health check status update occurs
3755
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003756 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3757 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003758 section 3.6 about mailers.
3759
3760
3761email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3762 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3764 yes | yes | yes | yes
3765
3766 Arguments :
3767
3768 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3769
3770 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3771 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3772
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003773 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3774 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003775
3776
3777email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3778 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3779 mailers.
3780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | yes | yes | yes
3782
3783 Arguments :
3784
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003785 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003786
3787 By default the systems hostname is used.
3788
3789 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3790 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3791 for the proxy.
3792
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003793 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3794 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003795
3796
3797email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003798 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003799 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | yes | yes | yes
3802
3803 Arguments :
3804
3805 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3806
3807 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3808 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3809
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003810 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003811 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3812
3813
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003814force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3815 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3816 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003817 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003818
3819 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3820 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3821 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3822 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3823 marked down for maintenance operations.
3824
3825 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3826 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3827 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3828 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3829 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3830 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3831 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3832 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3833 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3834
3835 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3836 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3837 is used.
3838
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003839 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003840 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003841
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003842
3843filter <name> [param*]
3844 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3846 no | yes | yes | yes
3847 Arguments :
3848 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3849 referenced in section 9.
3850
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003851 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003852 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003853 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3854 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003855
3856 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3857 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3858
3859 Example:
3860 listen
3861 bind *:80
3862
3863 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3864 filter compression
3865 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3866
3867 compression algo gzip
3868 compression offload
3869
3870 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3871
3872 See also : section 9.
3873
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003875fullconn <conns>
3876 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 yes | no | yes | yes
3879 Arguments :
3880 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3881 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3882
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003883 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003884 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003885 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003886 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3887 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3888 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3889 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3890 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003891 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003892
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003893 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3894 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003895 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3896 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3897 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003898
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003899 Example :
3900 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3901 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3902 # connections.
3903 backend dynamic
3904 fullconn 10000
3905 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3906 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3907
3908 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3909
3910
3911grace <time>
3912 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003914 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003915 Arguments :
3916 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3917 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3918 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3919
3920 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3921 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003922 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003923 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3924
3925 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3926 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3927 simplify it.
3928
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003929
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003930hash-balance-factor <factor>
3931 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3933 yes | no | no | yes
3934 Arguments :
3935 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3936 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01003937 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003938
3939 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3940 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3941 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3942 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3943 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3944 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3945 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3946
3947 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3948 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3949 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3950 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3951 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3952
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003953 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3954 consistent hashing mechanism.
3955
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003956 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3957
3958
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003959hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003960 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3961 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3962 yes | no | yes | yes
3963 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003964 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3965 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003966
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003967 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3968 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3969 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3970 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3971 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3972 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3973 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3974 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3975 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3976 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003977
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003978 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3979 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3980 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3981 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3982 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3983 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3984 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3985 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3986 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3987 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3988 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3989 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3990 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003991 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3992 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003993
3994 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3995
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003996 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003997 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3998 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3999 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004000 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4001 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4002 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004003
4004 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4005 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004006 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4007 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4008 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4009 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4010
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004011 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4012 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4013 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4014 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4015 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4016 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4017 parameter.
4018
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004019 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4020 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4021 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4022 used on strings.
4023
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004024 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4025
4026 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4027 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4028 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4029 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4030 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4031 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4032 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4033 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4034 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4035 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4036 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4037 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004038
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004039 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4040 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4041 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004042
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004043 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004044
4045
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004046http-check disable-on-404
4047 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004049 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004050 Arguments : none
4051
4052 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4053 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4054 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4055 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4056 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4057 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4058 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4059 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004060 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4061 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4062 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4063
4064 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
4065
4066
4067http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004068 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004070 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004071 Arguments :
4072 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
4073 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004074 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004075 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4076 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4077 details on the supported keywords.
4078
4079 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
4080 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
4081 with the usual backslash ('\').
4082
4083 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4084 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4085 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4086 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4087 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4088
4089 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004090 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004091 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
4092 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4093 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4094
4095 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004096 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004097 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4098 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4099 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4100 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4101
4102 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004103 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004104 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4105 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4106 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4107 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4108 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004109 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004110 trace).
4111
4112 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004113 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004114 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4115 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4116 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4117 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4118 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004119 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004120
4121 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4122 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4123 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4124 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4125 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4126 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4127 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4128 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4129
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004130 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4131 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4132 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4133
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004134 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4135 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4136
4137 Examples :
4138 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004139 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004140
4141 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004142 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004143
4144 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004145 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004146
4147 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004148 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004149
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004150 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004151
4152
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004153http-check send-state
4154 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4156 yes | no | yes | yes
4157 Arguments : none
4158
4159 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4160 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4161 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4162 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4163 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4164
4165 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4166 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4167 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4168 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4169 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004170 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4171 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4172 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4173
4174 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4175 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4176 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4177
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004178 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4179 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4180 checked in multiple backends.
4181
4182 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4183 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4184
4185 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4186 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4187 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4188 one fails.
4189
4190 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4191 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4192 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4193
4194 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4195 server's queue.
4196
4197 Example of a header received by the application server :
4198 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4199 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4200
4201 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4202
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004203
4204http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004205 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4206
4207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4208 no | yes | yes | yes
4209
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004210 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4211 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4212 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4213 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4214 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004216 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4217 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004219 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004220
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004221 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4222 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4223 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4224 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004225
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004226 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4227 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4228 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4229 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004230
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004231 Example:
4232 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4233 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4234 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004235
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004236 http-request allow if nagios
4237 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4238 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4239 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004240
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004241 Example:
4242 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4243 acl add path /addacl
4244 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004246 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004247
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004248 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4249 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004250
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004251 Example:
4252 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4253 acl setmap path /setmap
4254 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004255
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004256 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004257
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004258 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4259 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004261 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4262 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004265
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004266 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4267 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4268 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4269 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4270 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4271 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4272 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4273 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004276
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004277 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4278 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4279 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4280 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4281 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4282 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4283 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4284 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004286http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004288 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4289 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004290
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004294 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4295 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4296 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4297 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4298 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004299
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004300 Example:
4301 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4302 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004303
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004304http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004306 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004307
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004308http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4309 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004310
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004311 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4312 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4313 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4314 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4315 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4316 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4317 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4318 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4319 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4322 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4323 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4324 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4325 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4326 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004328http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4331 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4332 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4333 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4334 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4335 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004336
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004337http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004338
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004339 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004340
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004341http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004342
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004343 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4344 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4345 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4346 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4347 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4348 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004352 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4353 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4354 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4355 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4356 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004357
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02004358http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4359 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
4360 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
4361 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
4362
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01004363http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
4364
4365 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
4366 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
4367 pointed by <resolvers>.
4368 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
4369 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
4370 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
4371 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
4372 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
4373 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
4374 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
4375 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
4376 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
4377 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
4378 to 0.0.0.0.
4379
4380 Example:
4381 resolvers mydns
4382 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
4383 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
4384 timeout retry 1s
4385 hold valid 10s
4386 hold nx 3s
4387 hold other 3s
4388 hold obsolete 0s
4389 accepted_payload_size 8192
4390
4391 frontend fe
4392 bind 10.42.0.1:80
4393 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
4394 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
4395
4396 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
4397 # which mean DNS resolution error
4398 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
4399
4400 default_backend be
4401
4402 backend b_503
4403 # dummy backend used to return 503.
4404 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
4405 # 503 error page to end users
4406
4407 backend be
4408 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
4409 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
4410 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
4411 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
4412 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
4413
4414 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
4415 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
4416
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004417http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4418
4419 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4420 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4421 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4422 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004423 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4424 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004425
4426 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4427
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004428http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4431 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4432 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4433 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4434 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004435
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004436http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004437
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004438 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4439 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4440 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4441 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004443http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4444 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4447 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4448 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4449 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4450 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4451 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4452 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4453 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004454
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004455 Example:
4456 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004458 # applied to:
4459 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004460
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004461 # outputs:
4462 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004463
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004464 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004465
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02004466http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4467 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4468
4469 This matches the regular expression in the URI part of the request
4470 according to <match-regex>, and replaces it with the <replace-fmt>
4471 argument. Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a
4472 number are supported. The <fmt> field is interpreted as a log-format string
4473 so it may contain special expressions just like the <fmt> argument passed
4474 to "http-request set-uri". The match is exclusively case-sensitive. Any
4475 optional scheme, authority or query string are considered in the matching
4476 part of the URI. It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more
4477 expensive to evaluate than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit
4478 from a condition to avoid performing the evaluation at all if it does not
4479 match.
4480
4481 Example:
4482 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
4483 http-request replace-uri (.*) /foo\1
4484
4485 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
4486 http-request replace-uri ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
4487
4488 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
4489 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1
4490 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
4491 http-request replace-uri /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
4492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004493http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4494 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004495
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004496 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4497 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4498 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4499 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004501 Example:
4502 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004503
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004504 # applied to:
4505 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004506
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004507 # outputs:
4508 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004510http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4511http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004512
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004513 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4514 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4515 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004516
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004517http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004518
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004519 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4520 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4521 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004523http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004525 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4526 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4527 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4528 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4529 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004531 Arguments:
4532 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4533 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004535 Example:
4536 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4537 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4540 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004542http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4545 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4546 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004548 Arguments:
4549 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4550 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004552 Example:
4553 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4554 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004556 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4557 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4558 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004560http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004562 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4563 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4564 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4565 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4566 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004568 Example:
4569 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4570 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4571 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4572 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004579http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004581 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4582 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4583 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4584 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4585 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004587http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004590 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4591 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4592 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4593 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4594 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4595 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4596 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4597 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4598 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004600http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004602 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4603 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4604 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4605 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4606 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4607 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4608 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004610http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004612 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4613 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4614 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004616http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004618 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4619 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4620 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4621 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4622 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4623 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4624 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4625 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004627http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004629 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4630 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4631 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4632 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4633 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4634 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004636 Example :
4637 # prepend the host name before the path
4638 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004640http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004642 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4643 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4644 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4645 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4646 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004648http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004650 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4651 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4652 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4653 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4654 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4655 values have higher priority.
4656 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4657 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4658 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4659 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4660 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004662http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004664 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4665 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4666 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4667 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4668 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4669 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4670 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004672 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004673
4674 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004675 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4676 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004678http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4679 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4680 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4681 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4682 privacy.
4683
4684 Arguments :
4685 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4686 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004687
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004688 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004689 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4690 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4691
4692 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4693 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4694
4695http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4696
4697 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4698 expression.
4699
4700 Arguments:
4701 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4702 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004703
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004704 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004705 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4706 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4707
4708 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4709 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4710 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4711
4712http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4713
4714 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4715 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4716 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4717 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4718 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4719 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4720 information from the request.
4721
4722 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4723
4724http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4725
4726 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4727 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4728 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4729 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4730 path and the query string.
4731 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4732
4733http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4734
4735 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4736 inline.
4737
4738 Arguments:
4739 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4740 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4741 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4742 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4743 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4744 (request and response)
4745 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4746 processing
4747 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4748 processing
4749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4750 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4751 and '_'.
4752
4753 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4754 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004755
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004756 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004757 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004758
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004759http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4760 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004761
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004762 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4763 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4764 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4765 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4766 agent name must be used.
4767
4768 Arguments:
4769 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4770
4771 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4772 configuration.
4773
4774http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4775
4776 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4777 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4778 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4779 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4780 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4781 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4782 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4783 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4784 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4785 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4786 action.
4787 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4788 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4789 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4790 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4791 you fully understand how it works.
4792
4793http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4794
4795 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4796 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4797 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4798 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4799 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4800 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4801 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4802 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4803 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4804 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4805 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4806 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4807 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4808
4809http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4810http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4811http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4812
4813 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4814 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4815 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4816 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4817 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4818 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4819 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4820 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4821 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4822 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4823 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4824 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4825
4826 Arguments :
4827 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4828 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4829 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4830 select which table entry to update the counters.
4831
4832 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4833 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4834 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4835 that table until the session ends.
4836
4837 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4838 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4839 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4840 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4841 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4842 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4843 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4844 useful information.
4845
4846 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4847 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4848 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4849 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4850 checks that make use of it.
4851
4852http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4853
4854 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004855
4856 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004857 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004859http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004860
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004861 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4862 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4863 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004864
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004865
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004866http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004867 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4868
4869 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4870 no | yes | yes | yes
4871
4872 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4873 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4874 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4875 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4876 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4877 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4878
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004879 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4880 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004881
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004882 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004884 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4885 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4886 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4887 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004888
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004889 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4890 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4891 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4892 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004893
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004894 Example:
4895 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004896
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004897 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004898
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004899 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4900 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004901
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 Example:
4903 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004904
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004905 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4908 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004909
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004910 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4911 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004912
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004913http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004914
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004915 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4916 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4917 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4918 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4919 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4920 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4921 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4922 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004924http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004925
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004926 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4927 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4928 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4929 example, or to pass some internal information.
4930 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4931 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4932 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004933
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004934http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004935
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004936 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4937 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004938
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004939http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004941 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4946 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4947 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4948 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4949 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4950 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4951 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004953 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4954 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4955 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4956 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4957 keyword.
4958 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4959 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004961http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004963 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4964 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4965 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4966 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4967 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4968 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004970http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004972 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004974http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004976 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4977 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4978 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4979 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4980 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4981 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004983http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004984
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004985 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4986 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004987
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004988http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004989
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004990 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4991 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4992 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4993 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4994 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4995 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004996
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004997http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4998 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005000 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
5001 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
5002 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
5003 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
5004 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
5005 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
5006 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
5007 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005009 Example:
5010 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02005011
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005012 # applied to:
5013 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005015 # outputs:
5016 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005017
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005018 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005019
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005020http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005022
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005023 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5024 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
5025 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
5026 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005028 Example:
5029 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005031 # applied to:
5032 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005033
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005034 # outputs:
5035 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005036
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005037http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5038http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08005039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005040 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5041 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5042 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005043
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005044http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005045
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005046 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
5047 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
5048 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005050http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005051
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005052 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5053 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5054 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5055 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5056 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005057
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005058 Arguments:
5059 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005061 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5062 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005063
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005064http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005065
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005066 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5067 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5068 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005070http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5071
5072 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5073 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5074 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5075 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
5076 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
5077
5078http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5079
5080 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5081 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5082 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5083 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5084 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
5085 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5086 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5087 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
5088 be triggered by an HTTP response.
5089
5090http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5091
5092 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5093 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5094 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5095 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
5096 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
5097 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
5098 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
5099
5100http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5101
5102 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
5103 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
5104 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
5105 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
5106 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
5107 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5108 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5109 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
5110
5111http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5112 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5113
5114 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5115 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5116 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5117 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005118
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005119 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005120 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5121 http-response set-status 431
5122 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5123 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005124
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005125http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005127 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5128 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
5129 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
5130 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
5131 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
5132 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
5133 based on some information from the request.
5134
5135 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5136
5137http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5138
5139 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5140 inline.
5141
5142 Arguments:
5143 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5144 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5145 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5146 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5147 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5148 (request and response)
5149 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5150 processing
5151 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5152 processing
5153 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5154 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5155 and '_'.
5156
5157 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5158 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005159
5160 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005161 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005162
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005163http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005165 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5166 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5167 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5168 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5169 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5170 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5171 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5172 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5173 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5174 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5175 action.
5176 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5177 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5178 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5179 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5180 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005181
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005182http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5183http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5184http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005185
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005186 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
5187 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
5188 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
5189 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
5190 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
5191 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
5192
5193http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5194
5195 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
5196 about <var-name>.
5197
5198 Example:
5199 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5200
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02005201
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005202http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
5203 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
5204
5205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5206 yes | no | yes | yes
5207
5208 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005209 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
5210 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
5211 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005212
5213 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
5214
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005215 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
5216 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
5217 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5218 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5219 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5220 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5221 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5222 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5223 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5224 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005225
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005226 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5227 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5228 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5229 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5230 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5231 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5232 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5233 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005234
5235 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5236 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5237 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5238 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5239 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5240 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5241 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5242 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005243 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005244 downsides of rare connection failures.
5245
5246 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5247 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5248 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5249 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5250 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5251 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005252 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005253 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5254 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5255 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5256 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5257 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5258
5259 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005260 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5261 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5262 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005263
5264 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005265 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005266
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005267 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5268 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005269
5270 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5271 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5272 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5273
5274 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5275 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5276 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5277
5278 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5279
5280
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005281http-send-name-header [<header>]
5282 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005283 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5284 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005285 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005286 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5287
Willy Tarreaue0e32792019-10-07 14:58:02 +02005288 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
5289 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
5290 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
5291 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
5292 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
5293 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
5294 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
5295 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
5296 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
5297 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
5298 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
5299 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
5300 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
5301 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
5302 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
5303 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005304
5305 See also : "server"
5306
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005307id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005308 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 no | yes | yes | yes
5311 Arguments : none
5312
5313 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5314 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5315 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005316
5317
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005318ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5319 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5320 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005321 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005322
5323 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5324 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5325 and running).
5326
5327 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5328 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5329 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005330 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005331 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5332
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005333 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5334 "unless" condition is met.
5335
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005336 Example:
5337 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5338 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5339 ignore-persist if url_static
5340
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005341 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5342
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005343load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5344 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5345 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5346 yes | no | yes | yes
5347
5348 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5349 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5350 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005352 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5353 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5354 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5355 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5356
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005357 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005358 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005359 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005360
5361 Arguments:
5362 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5363 named "server-state-file".
5364
5365 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5366 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5367 name is used as a file name.
5368
5369 none don't load any stat for this backend
5370
5371 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005372 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5373 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5374 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005375 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005376 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005377
5378 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5379 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5380
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005381 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005382
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005383 global
5384 stats socket /tmp/socket
5385 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005386
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005387 defaults
5388 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005389
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005390 backend bk
5391 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5392 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005393
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005394
5395 Then one can run :
5396
5397 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5398
5399 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5400
5401 1
5402 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5403 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5404 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5405
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005406 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005407
5408 global
5409 stats socket /tmp/socket
5410 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5411
5412 defaults
5413 load-server-state-from-file local
5414
5415 backend bk
5416 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5417 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5418
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005419
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005420 Then one can run :
5421
5422 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5423
5424 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5425
5426 1
5427 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5428 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5429 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5430
5431 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5432 "show servers state"
5433
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005434
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005435log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005436log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
5437 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005438no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005439 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5440 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5441 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005442
5443 Prefix :
5444 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5445 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5446 prefix does not allow arguments.
5447
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005448 Arguments :
5449 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5450 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5451 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5452 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5453 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5454 parameter.
5455
5456 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5457 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5458
5459 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5460 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5461 standard syslog port).
5462
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005463 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5464 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5465 standard syslog port).
5466
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005467 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5468 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5469 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005470 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005471
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005472 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5473 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5474 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5475 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5476 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5477 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5478 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5479 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5480 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5481 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5482 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5483 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5484 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5485 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5486 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5487 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005488 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5489 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005490
5491 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5492 and "fd@2", see above.
5493
5494 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5495 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005496
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005497 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5498 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5499 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5500 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5501 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5502 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5503 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5504 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5505 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5506 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005507 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005508
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02005509 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
5510 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
5511 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
5512 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
5513 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
5514
5515 <sample_size>
5516 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
5517 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
5518 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
5519 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
5520 (see also <ranges> parameter).
5521
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005522 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5523 one of the following :
5524
5525 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5526 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5527
5528 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5529 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5530
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005531 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5532 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5533 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5534 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5535 systemd logger consumes.
5536
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005537 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5538 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5539 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5540 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5541
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005542 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5543
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005544 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5545 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5546 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5547
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005548 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5549 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5550 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5551 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005552
5553 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5554 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5555 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005556 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5557 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5558 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5559 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5560 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005561
5562 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5563
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005564 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5565 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5566 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005567
5568 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5569 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5570 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5571 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5572
5573 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5574 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005575
5576 Example :
5577 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005578 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5579 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5580 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005581 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5582 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005583 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005585
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005586log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005587 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5588 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5589 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005590
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005591 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5592 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5593 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5594 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5595 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005596
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005597 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5598 "option httplog" directives.
5599
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005600log-format-sd <string>
5601 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5603 yes | yes | yes | no
5604
5605 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5606 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5607 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5608 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5609 which covers the log format string in depth.
5610
5611 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5612 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5613
5614 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5615 log format to "rfc5424".
5616
5617 Example :
5618 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5619
5620
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005621log-tag <string>
5622 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5624 yes | yes | yes | yes
5625
5626 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5627 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5628 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5629 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5630 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5631 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5632 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5633 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5634 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005635
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005636max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5637 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5638 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5639 yes | no | yes | yes
5640
5641 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5642 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5643 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5644 servers.
5645
5646 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5647 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5648 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5649 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5650 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005651 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005652 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5653 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5654 picking a different server.
5655
5656 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5657 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5658 even if they have to be queued.
5659
5660 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5661 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5662
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005663max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5664 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5665 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5666 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005668maxconn <conns>
5669 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5671 yes | yes | yes | no
5672 Arguments :
5673 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5674 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5675 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5676 closes.
5677
5678 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5679 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5680 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5681 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005682 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5683 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5684 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5685 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005686
5687 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5688 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5689 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5690
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01005691 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
5692 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005693
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005694 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5695
5696
5697mode { tcp|http|health }
5698 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5700 yes | yes | yes | yes
5701 Arguments :
5702 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5703 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5704 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5705 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5706
5707 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5708 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5709 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5710 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5711 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5712
5713 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005714 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5715 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5716 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5717 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5718 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5719 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5720 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005721
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005722 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5723 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5724 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005725
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005726 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005727 defaults http_instances
5728 mode http
5729
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005730 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005731
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005732
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005733monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005734 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5736 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005737 Arguments :
5738 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5739 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005740 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005741 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5742 backend and its backup.
5743
5744 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5745 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5746 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5747 servers in a list of backends.
5748
5749 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5750 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5751 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5752 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5753 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5754 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5755 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005756 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5757 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005758
5759 Example:
5760 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005761 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005762 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5763 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5764 monitor-uri /site_alive
5765 monitor fail if site_dead
5766
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005767 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005768
5769
5770monitor-net <source>
5771 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5773 yes | yes | yes | no
5774 Arguments :
5775 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5776 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5777 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5778 followed by a mask.
5779
5780 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5781 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005782 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005783 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5784
5785 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5786 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5787 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5788 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005789 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5790 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5791 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005792
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005793 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5794 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5795 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5796 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5797 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5798 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005799
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005800 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5801 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005802
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005803 Example :
5804 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5805 frontend www
5806 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5807
5808 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5809
5810
5811monitor-uri <uri>
5812 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5814 yes | yes | yes | no
5815 Arguments :
5816 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5817 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5818
5819 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5820 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5821 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5822 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5823 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5824 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5825 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5826 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5827
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005828 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5829 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5830 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5831 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5832 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5833 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5834 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5835 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005836
5837 Example :
5838 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5839 frontend www
5840 mode http
5841 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5842
5843 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005845
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005846option abortonclose
5847no option abortonclose
5848 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | no | yes | yes
5851 Arguments : none
5852
5853 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5854 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5855 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5856 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005857 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005858 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5859 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5860 encountered while delivering the response.
5861
5862 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5863 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5864 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5865 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5866 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5867 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005868 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005869 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005870 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005871 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5872 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5873 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5874
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005875 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5876 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005877 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5878 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5879 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5880 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5881 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5882 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005883 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005884
5885 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5886 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5887
5888 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5889
5890
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005891option accept-invalid-http-request
5892no option accept-invalid-http-request
5893 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | yes | yes | no
5896 Arguments : none
5897
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005898 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005899 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005900 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005901 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5902 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5903 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5904 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5905 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005906 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5907 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5908 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5909 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005910 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005911 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005912 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5913 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5914 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005915
5916 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5917 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5918 been confirmed.
5919
5920 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5921 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005922 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5923 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005924 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5925
5926 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5927 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5928
5929 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5930 stats socket.
5931
5932
5933option accept-invalid-http-response
5934no option accept-invalid-http-response
5935 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5937 yes | no | yes | yes
5938 Arguments : none
5939
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005940 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005941 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005942 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005943 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5944 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5945 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5946 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5947 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005948 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5949 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5950 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005951
5952 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5953 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5954 been confirmed.
5955
5956 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5957 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5958 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5959 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5960
5961 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5962 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5963
5964 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5965 stats socket.
5966
5967
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005968option allbackups
5969no option allbackups
5970 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5972 yes | no | yes | yes
5973 Arguments : none
5974
5975 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5976 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5977 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5978 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5979 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5980 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5981 order between the backup servers anymore.
5982
5983 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5984 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5985
5986 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5987 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5988
5989
5990option checkcache
5991no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005992 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5994 yes | no | yes | yes
5995 Arguments : none
5996
5997 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5998 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005999 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006000 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
6001 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006002 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006003
6004 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006005 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006006 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006007 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
6008 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006009 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006010 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01006011 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
6012 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006013 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01006014 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
6015 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006016 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006017 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
6018 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
6019 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
6020 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
6021 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
6022 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
6023 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
6024 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
6025 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
6026
6027 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006028 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006029 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006030 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006031 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
6032
6033 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
6034 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006035 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006036 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006037
6038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6040
6041
6042option clitcpka
6043no option clitcpka
6044 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | yes | yes | no
6047 Arguments : none
6048
6049 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6050 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006051 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006052 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6053
6054 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6055 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6056 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6057 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6058
6059 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6060 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6061 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6062 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6063 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6064
6065 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6066
6067 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6068 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6069 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
6070
6071 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6072 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6073
6074 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
6075
6076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006077option contstats
6078 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6080 yes | yes | yes | no
6081 Arguments : none
6082
6083 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
6084 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
6085 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
6086 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01006087 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
6088 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
6089 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
6090 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
6091 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006092
6093
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006094option dontlog-normal
6095no option dontlog-normal
6096 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
6097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6098 yes | yes | yes | no
6099 Arguments : none
6100
6101 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
6102 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
6103 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
6104 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
6105 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
6106 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
6107 logged.
6108
6109 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
6110 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
6111 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
6112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006113 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006114 logging.
6115
6116
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006117option dontlognull
6118no option dontlognull
6119 Enable or disable logging of null connections
6120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6121 yes | yes | yes | no
6122 Arguments : none
6123
6124 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
6125 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
6126 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
6127 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
6128 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
6129 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006130 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
6131 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
6132 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006133
6134 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006135 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006136 would not be logged.
6137
6138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6140
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006141 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
6142 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006143
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006144
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006145option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006146 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
6147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6148 yes | yes | yes | yes
6149 Arguments :
6150 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6151 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006152 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006153 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006154
6155 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
6156 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
6157 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
6158 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
6159 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
6160 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
6161 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006162 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
6163 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6164 possible that the client has already brought one.
6165
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006166 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006167 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006168 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006169 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006170 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006171 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006172
6173 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6174 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6175 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6176 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6177 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6178 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6179 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6180
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006181 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
6182 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
6183 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
6184 are under the control of the end-user.
6185
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006186 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006187 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6188 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006189 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
6190 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
6191 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006192
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006193 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006194 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
6195 frontend www
6196 mode http
6197 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
6198
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02006199 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
6200 backend www
6201 mode http
6202 option forwardfor header X-Client
6203
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006204 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006205 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006206
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006207
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006208option http-buffer-request
6209no option http-buffer-request
6210 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
6211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6212 yes | yes | yes | yes
6213 Arguments : none
6214
6215 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
6216 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
6217 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
6218 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
6219 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
6220 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
6221 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
6222 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006223 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006224 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
6225 default.
6226
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01006227 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006228
6229
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006230option http-ignore-probes
6231no option http-ignore-probes
6232 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
6233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6234 yes | yes | yes | no
6235 Arguments : none
6236
6237 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6238 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6239 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6240 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6241 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6242 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6243 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6244 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6245 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006246 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6247 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006248 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6249
6250 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6251 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6252 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6253 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6254 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6255 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6256 are often the only way to detect them.
6257
6258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6260
6261 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6262
6263
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006264option http-keep-alive
6265no option http-keep-alive
6266 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6268 yes | yes | yes | yes
6269 Arguments : none
6270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006271 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6272 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006273 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6274 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6275 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6276 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6277 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006278
6279 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6280 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006281 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6282 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6283 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6284 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6285 situations where this option may be useful :
6286
6287 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006288 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006289
6290 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6291 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6292
6293 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6294 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6295 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6296 request.
6297
6298 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6299 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006300 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6301 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6302 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006303
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006304 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6305 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6306 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6307 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6308 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6309 not set.
6310
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006311 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006312 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6313 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006314
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006315 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006316 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006317 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006318
6319
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006320option http-no-delay
6321no option http-no-delay
6322 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6324 yes | yes | yes | yes
6325 Arguments : none
6326
6327 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6328 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6329 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6330 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6331 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6332 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6333 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6334 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6335 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6336 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6337 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6338 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6339 affected.
6340
6341 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6342 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6343 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6344 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6345 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6346 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6347 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6348 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6349 latency environments.
6350
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006351 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6352
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006353
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006354option http-pretend-keepalive
6355no option http-pretend-keepalive
6356 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006358 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006359 Arguments : none
6360
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006361 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006362 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6363 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6364 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6365 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6366 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6367 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6368 consider the response complete.
6369
6370 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6371 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6372 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6373 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006374 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006375 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6376
6377 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6378 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6379 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6380 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6381 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6382 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6383 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6384
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006385 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6386 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6387 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6388 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6389 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6390 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006391
6392 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6393 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6394
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006395 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006396 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006397
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006398
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006399option http-server-close
6400no option http-server-close
6401 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6403 yes | yes | yes | yes
6404 Arguments : none
6405
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006406 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6407 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6408 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6409 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006410 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6411 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6412 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6413 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6414 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6415 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6416 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6417 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6418 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6419 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6420 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006421
6422 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6423 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6424 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6425 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006426 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6427 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006428
6429 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6430 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006431 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6432 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6433 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006434
6435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6437
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006438 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6439 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006440
6441
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006442option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6443no option http-tunnel (deprecated)
6444 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006446 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006447 Arguments : none
6448
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +01006449 Warning : Because it cannot work in HTTP/2, this option is deprecated and it
6450 is only supported on legacy HTTP frontends. In HTX, it is ignored and a
6451 warning is emitted during HAProxy startup.
6452
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006453 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6454 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6455 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6456 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006457 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006458
6459 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006460 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006461 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6462 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6463 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6464 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6465 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6466 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6467 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006468
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006469 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6470 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6471 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6472 backend.
6473
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6476
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006477 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6478 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006479
6480
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006481option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006482no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006483 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6484 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6485 yes | yes | yes | no
6486 Arguments : none
6487
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006488 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006489 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6490 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6491 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6492 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6493 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6494 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6495
6496 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6497 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006498 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6499 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6500 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006501
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006502 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6503 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6504 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6505 front of an existing proxy.
6506
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006507 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6508
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006509 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006510
6511
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006512option http-use-htx
6513no option http-use-htx
6514 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6516 yes | yes | yes | yes
6517 Arguments : none
6518
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006519 Historically, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006520 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006521 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. This mode is known as the legacy
6522 HTTP mode. Since this principle has deep roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2
6523 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being processed this way. It also
6524 results in the inability to establish HTTP/2 connections to servers because
6525 of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1 representation.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006526
6527 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6528 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6529 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6530 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006531 most elements are directly accessed. It supports using either HTTP/1 or
6532 HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the other side's version. It also supports
6533 upgrades from TCP to HTTP and implicit ones from HTTP/1 to HTTP/2 (matching
6534 the HTTP/2 preface).
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006535
Christopher Faulet1d2b5862019-04-12 16:10:51 +02006536 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. Since the version 2.0-dev3,
6537 the HTX is the default mode. To switch back on the legacy HTTP mode, the
6538 option must be explicitly disabled using the "no" prefix. For prior versions,
6539 the feature has incomplete functional coverage, so it is not enabled by
6540 default.
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006541
6542 See also : "mode http"
6543
6544
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006545option httpchk
6546option httpchk <uri>
6547option httpchk <method> <uri>
6548option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6549 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6551 yes | no | yes | yes
6552 Arguments :
6553 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6554 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6555 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6556 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6557 ones.
6558
6559 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6560 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6561 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6562
6563 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6564 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6565 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6566 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6567 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6568
6569 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6570 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6571 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6572 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6573 the lack of any response.
6574
6575 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6576
6577 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6578 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6579 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6580
6581 Examples :
6582 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6583 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6584 backend https_relay
6585 mode tcp
6586 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6587 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6588
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006589 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6590 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6591 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006592
6593
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006594option httpclose
6595no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006596 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6598 yes | yes | yes | yes
6599 Arguments : none
6600
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006601 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6602 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6603 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6604 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006605 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006606
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006607 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6608 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05006609 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006610 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6611 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006612
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006613 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6614 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6615 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006616
6617 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6618 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006619 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006620 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6621 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6622 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006623
6624 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6625 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6626
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006627 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006628
6629
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006630option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006631 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006633 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006634 Arguments :
6635 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6636 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6637 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006638 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006639 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006640
6641 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6642 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6643 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6644 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6645 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6646 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6647 ports.
6648
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006649 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6650 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006651
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006652 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6653
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006654 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006655
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006656
6657option http_proxy
6658no option http_proxy
6659 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6661 yes | yes | yes | yes
6662 Arguments : none
6663
6664 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6665 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6666 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6667 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6668 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6669
6670 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6671 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006672 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6673 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006674
6675 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6676 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6677
6678 Example :
6679 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6680 backend direct_forward
6681 option httpclose
6682 option http_proxy
6683
6684 See also : "option httpclose"
6685
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006686
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006687option independent-streams
6688no option independent-streams
6689 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6691 yes | yes | yes | yes
6692 Arguments : none
6693
6694 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6695 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6696 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6697 receive data or not.
6698
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006699 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006700 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6701 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6702 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6703 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6704 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6705 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6706 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6707 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6708 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6709 socket buffers.
6710
6711 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6712 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6713 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6714 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6715 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6716
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006717 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006718 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6719 deprecated.
6720
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006721 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006722
6723
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006724option ldap-check
6725 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6726 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6727 yes | no | yes | yes
6728 Arguments : none
6729
6730 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6731 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6732 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6733 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6734
6735 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6736 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6737
6738 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6739 configure it.
6740
6741 Example :
6742 option ldap-check
6743
6744 See also : "option httpchk"
6745
6746
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006747option external-check
6748 Use external processes for server health checks
6749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6750 yes | no | yes | yes
6751
6752 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6753 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6754 command".
6755
6756 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6757
6758 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6759
6760
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006761option log-health-checks
6762no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006763 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6765 yes | no | yes | yes
6766 Arguments : none
6767
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006768 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6769 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6770 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006771
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006772 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6773 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6774 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6775 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6776 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6777
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006778 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006779 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006780
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006781 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6782 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6783 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006784
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006785
6786option log-separate-errors
6787no option log-separate-errors
6788 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6790 yes | yes | yes | no
6791 Arguments : none
6792
6793 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6794 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6795 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6796 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6797 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6798 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6799 provides very important information.
6800
6801 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6802 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6803 error logs.
6804
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006805 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006806 logging.
6807
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006808
6809option logasap
6810no option logasap
6811 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6813 yes | yes | yes | no
6814 Arguments : none
6815
6816 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6817 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6818 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6819 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6820 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6821 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6822 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006823 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006824 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6825 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6826
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006827 Examples :
6828 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6829 mode http
6830 option httplog
6831 option logasap
6832 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6833
6834 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6835 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6836 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6837 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6838
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006839 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006840 logging.
6841
6842
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006843option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006844 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006847 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006848 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6849 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006850 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006851
6852 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6853 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006854 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006855 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6856 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6857 in the MySQL table, like this :
6858
6859 USE mysql;
6860 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6861 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6862
6863 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006864 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006865 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6866 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6867 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6868 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6869 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6870 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6871 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6872
6873 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6874 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006875
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006876 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006877
6878 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6879 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6880 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6881 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006882 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6883 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006884
6885 See also: "option httpchk"
6886
6887
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006888option nolinger
6889no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006890 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006891 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6892 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006893 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006894
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006895 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006896 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6897 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6898 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6899 connections.
6900
6901 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6902 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6903 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6904 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6905 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6906 this too.
6907
6908 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6909 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6910 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6911
6912 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6913 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6914 for servers.
6915
6916 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6917 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6918
6919
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006920option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6921 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 yes | yes | yes | yes
6924 Arguments :
6925 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6926 matching <network>
6927 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6928 header name.
6929
6930 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6931 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6932 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6933 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6934 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6935 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6936 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6937 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6938 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6939 possible that the client has already brought one.
6940
6941 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6942 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6943 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6944 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6945 header and requires different one.
6946
6947 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6948 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6949 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6950 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6951 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6952 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6953 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6954
6955 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6956 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6957 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6958 both are defined.
6959
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006960 Examples :
6961 # Original Destination address
6962 frontend www
6963 mode http
6964 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6965
6966 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6967 backend www
6968 mode http
6969 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6970
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006971 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006972
6973
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006974option persist
6975no option persist
6976 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6977 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6978 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006979 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006980
6981 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6982 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6983 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6984 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6985 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6986 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6987 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6988 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6989 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6990 redirected to another valid server.
6991
6992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6994
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006995 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006996
6997
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006998option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6999 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 yes | no | yes | yes
7002 Arguments :
7003 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
7004 PostgreSQL server.
7005
7006 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
7007 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
7008 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
7009 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
7010
7011 See also: "option httpchk"
7012
7013
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007014option prefer-last-server
7015no option prefer-last-server
7016 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
7017 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7018 yes | no | yes | yes
7019 Arguments : none
7020
7021 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
7022 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
7023 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
7024 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
7025 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
7026 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
7027 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
7028 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
7029 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007030 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
7031 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02007032 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
7033 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
7034 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01007035 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
7036 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
7037 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007038
7039 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7040 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7041
7042 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
7043
7044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007045option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007046option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007047no option redispatch
7048 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7049 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7050 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007051 Arguments :
7052 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
7053 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
7054 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007055 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007056 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007057 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007058 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
7059 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
7060 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
7061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007062
7063 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7064 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7065 be able to access the service anymore.
7066
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01007067 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
7068 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007069
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007070 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007071 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7072 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007073
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007074 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
7075 "redisp" keywords.
7076
7077 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7078 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7079
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01007080 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007081
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007082
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007083option redis-check
7084 Use redis health checks for server testing
7085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7086 yes | no | yes | yes
7087 Arguments : none
7088
7089 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
7090 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7091 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
7092 find the "+PONG" response message.
7093
7094 Example :
7095 option redis-check
7096
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007097 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02007098
7099
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007100option smtpchk
7101option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
7102 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
7103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7104 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007105 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007106 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02007107 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007108 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
7109
7110 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
7111 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
7112 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
7113
7114 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
7115 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
7116 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
7117 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
7118 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
7119 dead server.
7120
7121 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
7122 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007123 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007124 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
7125
7126 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
7127 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
7128 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
7129 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02007130 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007131
7132 Example :
7133 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
7134
7135 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
7136
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007137
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02007138option socket-stats
7139no option socket-stats
7140
7141 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
7142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7143 yes | yes | yes | no
7144
7145 Arguments : none
7146
7147
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007148option splice-auto
7149no option splice-auto
7150 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
7151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7152 yes | yes | yes | yes
7153 Arguments : none
7154
7155 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
7156 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007157 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007158 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007159 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007160 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
7161 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
7162 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
7163 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7164
7165 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
7166 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
7167 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
7168 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
7169 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
7170 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
7171 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
7172 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
7173 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
7174 keyword.
7175
7176 Example :
7177 option splice-auto
7178
7179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7181
7182 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
7183 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7184
7185
7186option splice-request
7187no option splice-request
7188 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 yes | yes | yes | yes
7191 Arguments : none
7192
7193 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007194 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007195 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7196 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7197 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7198 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7199
7200 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7201
7202 Example :
7203 option splice-request
7204
7205 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7206 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7207
7208 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
7209 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7210
7211
7212option splice-response
7213no option splice-response
7214 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
7215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7216 yes | yes | yes | yes
7217 Arguments : none
7218
7219 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007220 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01007221 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
7222 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
7223 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
7224 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
7225
7226 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
7227
7228 Example :
7229 option splice-response
7230
7231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7233
7234 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
7235 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
7236
7237
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01007238option spop-check
7239 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7240 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7241 no | no | no | yes
7242 Arguments : none
7243
7244 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7245 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7246 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7247 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7248
7249 Example :
7250 option spop-check
7251
7252 See also : "option httpchk"
7253
7254
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007255option srvtcpka
7256no option srvtcpka
7257 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7258 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7259 yes | no | yes | yes
7260 Arguments : none
7261
7262 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7263 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007264 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007265 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7266
7267 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7268 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7269 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7270 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7271
7272 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7273 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7274 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7275 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7276 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7277
7278 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7279
7280 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7281 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7282 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7283
7284 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7285 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7286
7287 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7288
7289
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007290option ssl-hello-chk
7291 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7293 yes | no | yes | yes
7294 Arguments : none
7295
7296 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7297 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7298 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7299 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7300 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7301 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7302 hello message.
7303
7304 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7305 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7306 messages, which is appreciable.
7307
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007308 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7309 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7310 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007311
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007312 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7313
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007314
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007315option tcp-check
7316 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7318 yes | no | yes | yes
7319
7320 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7321 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7322
7323 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7324 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7325 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7326
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007327 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007328 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7329 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7330 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7331 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7332 only.
7333
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007334 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007335 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7336 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7337 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7338 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7339
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007340 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007341 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7342 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007343 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007344 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7345 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7346 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7347 the respective protocols.
7348 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007349 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007350
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007351 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7352 script.
7353
7354 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7355 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7356 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7357 The "comment" is of course optional.
7358
7359
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007360 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007361 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007362 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007363 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007364
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007365 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007366 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007367 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007368
7369 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7370 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007371 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007372 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007373 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007374 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007375 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007376 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007377 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7378 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007379 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007380 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7381 tcp-check expect string +OK
7382
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007383 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007384 (send many headers before analyzing)
7385 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007386 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007387 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7388 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7389 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7390 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007391 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007392
7393
7394 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7395
7396
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007397option tcp-smart-accept
7398no option tcp-smart-accept
7399 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7400 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7401 yes | yes | yes | no
7402 Arguments : none
7403
7404 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7405 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7406 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7407 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7408 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7409 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7410
7411 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7412 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7413 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7414 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7415
7416 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7417 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7418 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007419 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007420
7421 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7422 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7423 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7424
7425 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7426 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7427 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7428
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007429 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7430
7431
7432option tcp-smart-connect
7433no option tcp-smart-connect
7434 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7436 yes | no | yes | yes
7437 Arguments : none
7438
7439 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7440 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7441 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7442 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7443 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7444
7445 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7446 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7447 complex.
7448
7449 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7450 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7451 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7452
7453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7455
7456 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7457
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007458
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007459option tcpka
7460 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7462 yes | yes | yes | yes
7463 Arguments : none
7464
7465 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7466 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007467 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007468 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7469
7470 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7471 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7472 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7473 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7474
7475 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7476 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7477 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7478 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7479 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7480
7481 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7482
7483 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7484 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7485 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7486 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7487 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7488 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7489 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7490 backends.
7491
7492 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7493
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007494
7495option tcplog
7496 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007498 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007499 Arguments : none
7500
7501 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7502 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7503 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7504 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7505 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7506 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7507 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7508 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7509
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007510 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7511
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007512 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007513
7514
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007515option transparent
7516no option transparent
7517 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007519 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007520 Arguments : none
7521
7522 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7523 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7524 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7525 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7526 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7527 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7528 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7529 appropriate server.
7530
7531 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7532 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7533
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007534 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007535 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007536
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007537
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007538external-check command <command>
7539 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7541 yes | no | yes | yes
7542
7543 Arguments :
7544 <command> is the external command to run
7545
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007546 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7547
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007548 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007549
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007550 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7551 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7552 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7553 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7554 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7555 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007556
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007557 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7558
7559 Environment variables :
7560 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7561 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7562
7563 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7564
7565 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7566
7567 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7568 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7569 for a UNIX socket).
7570
7571 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7572
7573 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7574
7575 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7576
7577 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7578
7579 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7580
7581 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7582 socket).
7583
7584 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7585 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7586
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02007587 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
7588
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007589 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7590 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7591 failed.
7592
7593 Example :
7594 external-check command /bin/true
7595
7596 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7597
7598
7599external-check path <path>
7600 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7602 yes | no | yes | yes
7603
7604 Arguments :
7605 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7606
7607 The default path is "".
7608
7609 Example :
7610 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7611
7612 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7613 "external-check command"
7614
7615
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007616persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007617persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007618 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7620 yes | no | yes | yes
7621 Arguments :
7622 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007623 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7624 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007625
7626 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7627 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007628 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007629 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7630 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7631 forwarded to this server.
7632
7633 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7634 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7635 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007636 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007637 a single "listen" section.
7638
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007639 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7640 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7641 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7642
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007643 Example :
7644 listen tse-farm
7645 bind :3389
7646 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7647 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7648 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7649 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7650 persist rdp-cookie
7651 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007652 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007653 balance rdp-cookie
7654 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7655 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7656
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007657 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7658 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007659
7660
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007661rate-limit sessions <rate>
7662 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7664 yes | yes | yes | no
7665 Arguments :
7666 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7667 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7668
7669 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7670 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7671 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7672 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7673 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7674 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7675
7676 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7677 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7678 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7679 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7680
7681 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7682 listen smtp
7683 mode tcp
7684 bind :25
7685 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007686 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007687
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007688 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7689 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7690 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007691
7692 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7693
7694
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007695redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7696redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7697redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007698 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7700 no | yes | yes | yes
7701
7702 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007703 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007704
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007705 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007706 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007707 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7708 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7709 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007710
7711 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7712 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7713 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7714 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7715 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007716 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7717 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7718 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7719 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007720
7721 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7722 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7723 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7724 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7725 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7726 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007727 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007728 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007729 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7730 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7731 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007732
7733 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007734 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7735 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7736 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007737 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007738 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7739 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7740 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7741 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007742
7743 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007744 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007745
7746 - "drop-query"
7747 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7748 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7749 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7750 with a location-type redirect.
7751
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007752 - "append-slash"
7753 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7754 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7755 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7756 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7757
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007758 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7759 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7760 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7761 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7762 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7763 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7764 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7765
7766 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7767 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7768 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7769 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7770 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7771 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7772 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007773
7774 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7775 acl clear dst_port 80
7776 acl secure dst_port 8080
7777 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007778 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007779 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007780 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7781
7782 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007783 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7784 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7785 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007786 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007787
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007788 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7789 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7790 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7791
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007792 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007793 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007794
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007795 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007796 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7797 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7798 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007800 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007801
7802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007803redisp (deprecated)
7804redispatch (deprecated)
7805 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007808 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007809
7810 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7811 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7812 be able to access the service anymore.
7813
7814 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7815 redistribute them to a working server.
7816
7817 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7818 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7819 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007820
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007821 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7822 "option redispatch" instead.
7823
7824 See also : "option redispatch"
7825
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007826
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007827reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007828 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 no | yes | yes | yes
7831 Arguments :
7832 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7833 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007834 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007835
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007836 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7837 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7838
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007839 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7840 the last header of an HTTP request.
7841
7842 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7843 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7844 responses.
7845
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007846 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7847 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7848 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7849
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007850 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7851 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007852
7853
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007854reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7855reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007856 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7858 no | yes | yes | yes
7859 Arguments :
7860 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7861 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7862 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7863 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7864 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7865 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7866 ignores case.
7867
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007868 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7869 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7870
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007871 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7872 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7873 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7874 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007875 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007876
7877 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7878 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7879
7880 Example :
7881 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7882 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7883 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7884
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007885 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7886 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007887
7888
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007889reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7890reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007891 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7893 no | yes | yes | yes
7894 Arguments :
7895 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7896 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7897 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7898 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7899 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7900 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7901
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007902 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7903 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7904
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007905 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7906 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7907 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7908 next servers.
7909
7910 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7911 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7912 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7913
7914 Example :
7915 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7916 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7917 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7918
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007919 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7920 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007921
7922
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007923reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7924reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007925 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7927 no | yes | yes | yes
7928 Arguments :
7929 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7930 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7931 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7932 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7933 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7934 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7935 case.
7936
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007937 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7938 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7939
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007940 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7941 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7942 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7943 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007944 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007945
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007946 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007947 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007948 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007949
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007950 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7951 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7952
7953 Example :
7954 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7955 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7956 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7957
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007958 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7959 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007960
7961
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007962reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7963reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007964 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7966 no | yes | yes | yes
7967 Arguments :
7968 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7969 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7970 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7971 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7972 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7973 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7974 case.
7975
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007976 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7977 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7978
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7980 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7981 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7982 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7983
7984 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7985 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7986
7987 Example :
7988 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7989 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7990 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7991 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7992
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007993 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7994 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007995
7996
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02007997reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
7998reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007999 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
8000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8001 no | yes | yes | yes
8002 Arguments :
8003 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8004 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8005 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8006 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8007 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
8008 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
8009
8010 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8011 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8012 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8013 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008014 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008015
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008016 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8017 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8018
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008019 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
8020 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
8021 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
8022
8023 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8024 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8025 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8026 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
8027 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
8028
8029 Example :
8030 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008031 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008032 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
8033 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
8034
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008035 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
8036 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008037
8038
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008039reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8040reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008041 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
8042 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8043 no | yes | yes | yes
8044 Arguments :
8045 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8046 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
8047 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
8048 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
8049 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
8050 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
8051 ignores case.
8052
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008053 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8054 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8055
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008056 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8057 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008058 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
8059 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
8060 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008061 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
8062 not set.
8063
8064 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
8065 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
8066 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
8067 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
8068 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
8069
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008070 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008071 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008072 # block all others.
8073 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
8074 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
8075
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01008076 # block bad guys
8077 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
8078 reqitarpit . if badguys
8079
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008080 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
8081 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008082
8083
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008084retries <value>
8085 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8086 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8087 yes | no | yes | yes
8088 Arguments :
8089 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8090 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8091 default value is 3.
8092
8093 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8094 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8095 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8096
8097 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008098 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8099 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008100
8101 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8102 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8103
8104 See also : "option redispatch"
8105
8106
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008107retry-on [list of keywords]
8108 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request
8109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8110 yes | no | yes | yes
8111 Arguments :
8112 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8113 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8114 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8115 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8116
8117 none never retry
8118
8119 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8120 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8121
8122 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
8123 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
8124 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
8125 request timeout on the server side, poor network
8126 condition, or a server crash or restart while
8127 processing the request.
8128
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02008129 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
8130 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
8131 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
8132 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
8133 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
8134 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
8135 overflow attack for example).
8136
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008137 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
8138 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
8139 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
8140 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
8141 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
8142 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
8143 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
8144 amplify denial of service attacks.
8145
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02008146 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
8147 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
8148 considered to be safe to retry.
8149
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008150 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
8151 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
8152 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
8153 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
8154
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02008155 all-retryable-errors
8156 retry request for any error that are considered
8157 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
8158 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
8159 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
8160
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008161 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
8162 not cumulative.
8163
8164 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
8165 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
8166 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
8167 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
8168
8169 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
8170 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
8171 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
8172 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
8173 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
8174 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
8175 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
8176 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
8177 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
8178 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
8179 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
8180 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
8181
8182 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
8183 should not use this directive.
8184
8185 The default is "conn-failure".
8186
8187 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
8188
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008189rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008190 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 no | yes | yes | yes
8193 Arguments :
8194 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8195 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008196 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008197
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008198 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8199 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8200
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008201 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
8202 the last header of an HTTP response.
8203
8204 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8205 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8206 responses.
8207
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008208 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
8209 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008210
8211
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008212rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8213rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008214 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
8215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8216 no | yes | yes | yes
8217 Arguments :
8218 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8219 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8220 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8221 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8222 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8223 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
8224 ignores case.
8225
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008226 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8227 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8228
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008229 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
8230 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008231 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008232 client.
8233
8234 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8235 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8236 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
8237
8238 Example :
8239 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02008240 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008241
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008242 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
8243 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008244
8245
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008246rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8247rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008248 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
8249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8250 no | yes | yes | yes
8251 Arguments :
8252 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8253 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8254 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8255 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8256 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8257 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
8258 ignores case.
8259
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008260 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8261 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8262
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008263 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
8264 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
8265 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
8266 case-sensitive.
8267
8268 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01008269 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
8270 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
8271 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008272
8273 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
8274 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
8275
8276 Example :
8277 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
8278 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
8279
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008280 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
8281 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008282
8283
Willy Tarreau96d51952019-05-22 20:34:35 +02008284rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (deprecated)
8285rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case) (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008286 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
8287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8288 no | yes | yes | yes
8289 Arguments :
8290 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
8291 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
8292 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
8293 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
8294 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
8295 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
8296 ignores case.
8297
8298 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
8299 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
8300 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
8301 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008302 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008303
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01008304 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
8305 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
8306
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008307 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
8308 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
8309 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
8310
8311 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
8312 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
8313 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
8314 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
8315 are not case-sensitive.
8316
8317 Example :
8318 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
8319 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
8320
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008321 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
8322 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008323
8324
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008325server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008326 Declare a server in a backend
8327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8328 no | no | yes | yes
8329 Arguments :
8330 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008331 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008332 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008333
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008334 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8335 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8336 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8337 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008338 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8339 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8340 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8341 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8342 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008343 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8344 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8345 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8346 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8347 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8348 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8349 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008350 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008351 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8352 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8353 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8354 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8355 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8356 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008357 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8358 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008359 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8360 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008361
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008362 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008363 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8364 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8365 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8366 adding this value to the client's port.
8367
8368 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8369 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008370 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008371
8372 Examples :
8373 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8374 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008375 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008376 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8377 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8378 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008379
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008380 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8381 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8382 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8383 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8384 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8385
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008386 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8387 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008388
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008389server-state-file-name [<file>]
8390 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8391 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8392 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8393 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8394 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8395 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8396
8397 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8398 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8399
8400 global
8401 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8402
8403 backend bk
8404 load-server-state-from-file
8405
8406 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8407 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008408
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008409server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8410 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8411 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 no | no | yes | yes
8414
8415 Arguments:
8416 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8417
8418 <num | range>
8419 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8420 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8421 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8422 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8423
8424 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8425
8426 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8427
8428 <params*>
8429 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8430 keyword.
8431
8432 Examples:
8433 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8434 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8435 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8436
8437 # or
8438 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8439
8440 # would be equivalent to:
8441 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8442 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8443 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8444
8445
8446
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008447source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008448source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008449source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008450 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8452 yes | no | yes | yes
8453 Arguments :
8454 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8455 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008456
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008457 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008458 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8459 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8460 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8461 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8462 supported prefixes are :
8463 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8464 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8465 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008466 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008467 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8468 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008469
8470 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8471 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008472 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8473 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8474 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008475
8476 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8477 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8478 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8479 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8480 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8481 <addr>.
8482
8483 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8484 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8485 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8486 port.
8487
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008488 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8489 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8490 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8491 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008492 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008493 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8494 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8495 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8496 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8497 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8498 HTTP header.
8499
8500 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8501 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008502 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008503 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8504 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8505 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8506 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8507 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8508 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8509 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8510
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008511 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8512 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8513 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8514 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8515 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8516 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8517
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008518 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8519 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8520 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8521 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8522
8523 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8524 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8525 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8526 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8527 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8528 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8529
8530 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8531 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8532 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8533 there are two methods :
8534
8535 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8536 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8537 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8538 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8539 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8540 of the client ranges may be used.
8541
8542 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8543 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8544 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8545 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8546 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8547 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8548 same session.
8549
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008550 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8551 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8552 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008553 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008554
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008555 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8556
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008557 Examples :
8558 backend private
8559 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8560 source 192.168.1.200
8561
8562 backend transparent_ssl1
8563 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8564 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8565
8566 backend transparent_ssl2
8567 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8568 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8569 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8570
8571 backend transparent_ssl3
8572 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8573 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8574 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8575
8576 backend transparent_smtp
8577 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8578 # with Tproxy version 4.
8579 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8580
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008581 backend transparent_http
8582 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8583 # proxy.
8584 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8585
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008586 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008587 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8588
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008589
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008590srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8591 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | no | yes | yes
8594 Arguments :
8595 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8596 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8597 as explained at the top of this document.
8598
8599 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8600 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8601 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8602 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8603 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8604 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8605 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8606
8607 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8608 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8609 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8610 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8611 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008612 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008613 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008614 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008615
8616 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8617 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8618 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8619 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8620 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8621 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8622
8623 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8624 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8625
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008626 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8627 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008628
8629
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008630stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8631 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008633 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008634
8635 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8636 matched.
8637
8638 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8639 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8640
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008641 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8642 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008643 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008644
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008645 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8646 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8647 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8648 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008649
8650 Example :
8651 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8652 backend stats_localhost
8653 stats enable
8654 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8655
8656 Example :
8657 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8658 backend stats_auth
8659 stats enable
8660 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8661 stats admin if TRUE
8662
8663 Example :
8664 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8665 userlist stats-auth
8666 group admin users admin
8667 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8668 group readonly users haproxy
8669 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8670
8671 backend stats_auth
8672 stats enable
8673 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8674 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8675 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8676 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8677
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008678 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8679 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8680 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008681
8682
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008683stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8684 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008686 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008687 Arguments :
8688 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8689
8690 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8691
8692 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8693 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8694 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8695 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8696 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8697 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8698
8699 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8700 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8701 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008702 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008703
8704 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8705 report using "stats scope".
8706
8707 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8708 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8709 unobvious parameters.
8710
8711 Example :
8712 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8713 backend public_www
8714 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8715 stats enable
8716 stats hide-version
8717 stats scope .
8718 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008719 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008720 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8721 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8722
8723 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8724 backend private_monitoring
8725 stats enable
8726 stats uri /admin?stats
8727 stats refresh 5s
8728
8729 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8730
8731
8732stats enable
8733 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008735 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008736 Arguments : none
8737
8738 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8739 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8740 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8741 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8742 - stats auth : no authentication
8743 - stats scope : no restriction
8744
8745 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8746 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8747 unobvious parameters.
8748
8749 Example :
8750 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8751 backend public_www
8752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8753 stats enable
8754 stats hide-version
8755 stats scope .
8756 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008757 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008758 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8759 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8760
8761 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8762 backend private_monitoring
8763 stats enable
8764 stats uri /admin?stats
8765 stats refresh 5s
8766
8767 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8768
8769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008770stats hide-version
8771 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008772 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008773 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008774 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008775
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008776 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8777 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8778 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8779 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8780 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8781 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008783 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8784 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8785 unobvious parameters.
8786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008787 Example :
8788 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8789 backend public_www
8790 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008791 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008792 stats hide-version
8793 stats scope .
8794 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008795 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008796 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8797 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008798
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008799 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8800 backend private_monitoring
8801 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008802 stats uri /admin?stats
8803 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008804
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008805 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008806
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008807
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008808stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8809 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8810 Access control for statistics
8811
8812 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 no | no | yes | yes
8814
8815 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8816 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8817 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8818 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8819 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8820 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8821
8822 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8823 instance.
8824
8825 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8826 about ACL usage.
8827
8828
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008829stats realm <realm>
8830 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008832 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008833 Arguments :
8834 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8835 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8836 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8837
8838 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8839 using a backslash ('\').
8840
8841 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8842 only related to authentication.
8843
8844 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8845 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8846 unobvious parameters.
8847
8848 Example :
8849 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8850 backend public_www
8851 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8852 stats enable
8853 stats hide-version
8854 stats scope .
8855 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008856 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008857 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8858 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8859
8860 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8861 backend private_monitoring
8862 stats enable
8863 stats uri /admin?stats
8864 stats refresh 5s
8865
8866 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8867
8868
8869stats refresh <delay>
8870 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008872 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008873 Arguments :
8874 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8875 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8876 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8877 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8878 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8879 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8880
8881 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8882 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8883 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8884 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8885
8886 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8887 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8888 unobvious parameters.
8889
8890 Example :
8891 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8892 backend public_www
8893 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8894 stats enable
8895 stats hide-version
8896 stats scope .
8897 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008898 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008899 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8900 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8901
8902 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8903 backend private_monitoring
8904 stats enable
8905 stats uri /admin?stats
8906 stats refresh 5s
8907
8908 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8909
8910
8911stats scope { <name> | "." }
8912 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008914 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008915 Arguments :
8916 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8917 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8918 section in which the statement appears.
8919
8920 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8921 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8922 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8923 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8924 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8925 exists.
8926
8927 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8928 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8929 unobvious parameters.
8930
8931 Example :
8932 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8933 backend public_www
8934 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8935 stats enable
8936 stats hide-version
8937 stats scope .
8938 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008939 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008940 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8941 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8942
8943 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8944 backend private_monitoring
8945 stats enable
8946 stats uri /admin?stats
8947 stats refresh 5s
8948
8949 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8950
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008951
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008952stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008953 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008955 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008956
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008957 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008958 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8959
8960 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8961 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8962
8963 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8964 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008965 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008966
8967 Example :
8968 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8969 backend private_monitoring
8970 stats enable
8971 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8972 stats uri /admin?stats
8973 stats refresh 5s
8974
8975 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8976 global section.
8977
8978
8979stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008980 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8982 yes | yes | yes | yes
8983 Arguments : none
8984
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008985 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008986 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8987 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8988 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8989 - IP (socket, server)
8990 - cookie (backend, server)
8991
8992 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8993 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008994 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008995
8996 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8997
8998
8999stats show-node [ <name> ]
9000 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009002 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009003 Arguments:
9004 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9005 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9006
9007 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9008 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009009 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009010
9011 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9012 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9013 unobvious parameters.
9014
9015 Example:
9016 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9017 backend private_monitoring
9018 stats enable
9019 stats show-node Europe-1
9020 stats uri /admin?stats
9021 stats refresh 5s
9022
9023 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9024 section.
9025
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009026
9027stats uri <prefix>
9028 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009030 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009031 Arguments :
9032 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9033 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9034 query string.
9035
9036 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9037 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9038 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9039 possible to reach it in the application.
9040
9041 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009042 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009043 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9044 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9045 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9046 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9047
9048 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9049 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9050 an address or a port to statistics only.
9051
9052 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9053 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9054 unobvious parameters.
9055
9056 Example :
9057 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9058 backend public_www
9059 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9060 stats enable
9061 stats hide-version
9062 stats scope .
9063 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009065 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9066 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9067
9068 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9069 backend private_monitoring
9070 stats enable
9071 stats uri /admin?stats
9072 stats refresh 5s
9073
9074 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9075
9076
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009077stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9078 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009080 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009081
9082 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009083 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009084 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009085 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009086 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9087
9088 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9089 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9090 the "stick-table" statement.
9091
9092 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9093 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9094 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9095 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9096 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9097
9098 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9099 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9100 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9101 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9102 transformation rules.
9103
9104 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9105 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9106 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9107 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9108 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9109 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9110 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9111
9112 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9113 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9114 ACL based conditions.
9115
9116 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9117 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9118 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9119 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9120
9121 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9122 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9123 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9124 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9125
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009126 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9127 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009128 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009129
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009130 Example :
9131 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9132 # last 30 minutes
9133 backend pop
9134 mode tcp
9135 balance roundrobin
9136 stick store-request src
9137 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9138 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9139 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9140
9141 backend smtp
9142 mode tcp
9143 balance roundrobin
9144 stick match src table pop
9145 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9146 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9147
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009148 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009149 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009150
9151
9152stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9153 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9155 no | no | yes | yes
9156
9157 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9158 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9159 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9160 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9161
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009162 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9163 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009164 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009165
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009166 Examples :
9167 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009168 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009169
9170 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9171 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9172 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9173
9174
9175 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9176 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9177 backend http
9178 mode http
9179 balance roundrobin
9180 stick on src table https
9181 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9182 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9183 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9184
9185 backend https
9186 mode tcp
9187 balance roundrobin
9188 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9189 stick on src
9190 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9191 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9192
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009193 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009194
9195
9196stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9197 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9199 no | no | yes | yes
9200
9201 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009202 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009203 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009205 server is selected.
9206
9207 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9208 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9209 the "stick-table" statement.
9210
9211 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9212 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9213 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9214 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9215 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9216 address.
9217
9218 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9219 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9220 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9221 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9222 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9223 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9224 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9225 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9226 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9227 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9228
9229 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9230 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9231 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9232 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9233 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9234 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9235 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9236
9237 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9238 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9239 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9240 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9241
9242 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9243 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9244 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9245 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9246 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9247 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009248 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9249 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9250 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9251 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9252 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9253 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009254
9255 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9256 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9257 the request.
9258
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009259 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9260 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009261 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009262
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009263 Example :
9264 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9265 # last 30 minutes
9266 backend pop
9267 mode tcp
9268 balance roundrobin
9269 stick store-request src
9270 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9271 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9272 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9273
9274 backend smtp
9275 mode tcp
9276 balance roundrobin
9277 stick match src table pop
9278 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9279 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9280
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009281 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009282 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009283
9284
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009285stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009286 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9287 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009288 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009289 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009290 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009291
9292 Arguments :
9293 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9294 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9295 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9296 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9297
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01009298 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
9299 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
9300 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9301 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9302
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009303 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
9304 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
9305 instance.
9306
9307 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
9308 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
9309 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
9310 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
9311 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
9312 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009313 to 32 characters.
9314
9315 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
9316 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
9317 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009318 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009319 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
9320 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009321
9322 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009323 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9324 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009325 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9326 increase.
9327
9328 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009329 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9330 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9331 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009332
9333 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9334 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9335 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9336 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009337 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009338 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9339 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9340 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9341 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9342 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9343 parameter (see below).
9344
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009345 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9346 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9347 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9348 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9349 soft restart.
9350
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009351 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9352 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009353
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009354 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9355 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9356 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9357 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009358 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009359 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009360 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9361 if not expiration delay is specified.
9362
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009363 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9364 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9365 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9366 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009367 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9368 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9369 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9370 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9371 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9372 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9373 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9374 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9375 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9376 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9377 types and their arguments.
9378
9379 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9380 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9381 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9382 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9383
9384 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9385 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9386 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009387 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009388
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009389 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9390 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9391 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009392 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009393 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009394 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009395
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009396 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9397 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9398 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9399 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9400
9401 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9402 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9403 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9404 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9405 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9406 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9407
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009408 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9409 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9410 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9411 they were received.
9412
9413 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9414 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9415 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9416 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9417 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9418
9419 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9420 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9421 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9422 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9423 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9424
9425 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9426 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9427 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9428
9429 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9430 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9431 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9432 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9433 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9434
9435 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9436 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9437 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9438 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9439 the client side.
9440
9441 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9442 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9443 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9444 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9445 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9446 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9447 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9448
9449 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9450 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9451 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9452 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9453 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9454 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009456
9457 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9458 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9459 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9460 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9461 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9462 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9463
9464 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009465 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009466 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9467 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9468
9469 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9470 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9471 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9472 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9473 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9474 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9475 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9476 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9477 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9478 recommended for better fairness.
9479
9480 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009481 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009482 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9483 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9484
9485 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9486 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9487 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9488 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9489 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9490 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9491 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9492 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9493 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9494 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009495
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009496 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9497 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009498 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9499 reference it.
9500
9501 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9502 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009503 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9504 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9505 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009506
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009507 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9508 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9509 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9510 something that can be ignored.
9511
9512 Example:
9513 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9514 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9515 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9516 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9517
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009518 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009519 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009520
9521
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009522stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009523 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9525 no | no | yes | yes
9526
9527 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009528 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009529 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009530 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009531 server is selected.
9532
9533 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9534 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9535 the "stick-table" statement.
9536
9537 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9538 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9539 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9540 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9541
9542 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9543 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9544 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9545 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9546 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9547 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009548 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009549 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9550 rules.
9551
9552 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9553 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9554 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9555 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9556 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9557 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9558 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9559
9560 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9561 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9562 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9563 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9564
9565 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9566 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9567 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9568 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9569 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9570 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009571 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9572 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9573 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9574 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9575 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9576 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9577 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9578 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9579 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009580
9581 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9582
9583 Example :
9584 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9585 backend https
9586 mode tcp
9587 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009588 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009589 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009590
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009591 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9592 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9593
9594 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9595 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9596 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9597
9598 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9599 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009600
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009601 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9602 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9603 # at offset 44.
9604
9605 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9606 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9607
9608 # Learn on response if server hello.
9609 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009610
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009611 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9612 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9613
9614 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9615 extraction.
9616
9617
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009618tcp-check connect [params*]
9619 Opens a new connection
9620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 no | no | yes | yes
9622
9623 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9624 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9625 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9626
9627 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9628 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9629 of the sequence.
9630
9631 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9632 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9633 do.
9634
9635 Parameters :
9636 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9637 use the TCP connection.
9638
9639 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9640 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9641 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9642
9643 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9644
9645 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9646
9647 Examples:
9648 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9649 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9650 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9651 option tcp-check
9652 tcp-check connect
9653 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9654 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9655 tcp-check send \r\n
9656 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9657 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9658 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9659 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9660 tcp-check send \r\n
9661 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9662 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9663
9664 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9665 option tcp-check
9666 tcp-check connect port 110
9667 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9668 tcp-check connect port 143
9669 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9670 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9671
9672 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9673
9674
9675tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009676 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009677 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9678 no | no | yes | yes
9679
9680 Arguments :
9681 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9682 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9683 binary.
9684 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9685 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9686 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9687
9688 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9689 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9690 with the usual backslash ('\').
9691 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009692 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009693 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9694 used upper or lower case.
9695
9696
9697 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9698
9699 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9700 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9701 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9702 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9703 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9704 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9705 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9706 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9707
9708 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9709 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9710 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9711 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9712 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9713 expression.
9714
9715 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9716 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9717 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9718 this exact hexadecimal string.
9719 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9720
9721 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9722 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9723 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9724 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9725 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9726 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9727 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9728 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9729 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9730 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9731 the null character.
9732
9733 Examples :
9734 # perform a POP check
9735 option tcp-check
9736 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9737
9738 # perform an IMAP check
9739 option tcp-check
9740 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9741
9742 # look for the redis master server
9743 option tcp-check
9744 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009745 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009746 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9747 tcp-check expect string role:master
9748 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9749 tcp-check expect string +OK
9750
9751
9752 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9753 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9754
9755
9756tcp-check send <data>
9757 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9759 no | no | yes | yes
9760
9761 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9762 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9763
9764 Examples :
9765 # look for the redis master server
9766 option tcp-check
9767 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9768 tcp-check expect string role:master
9769
9770 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9771 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9772
9773
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009774tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9775 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009776 tcp health check
9777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9778 no | no | yes | yes
9779
9780 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9781 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009782 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009783 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9784 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9785 hexadecimal string.
9786 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9787
9788 Examples :
9789 # redis check in binary
9790 option tcp-check
9791 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9792 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9793
9794
9795 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9796 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9797
9798
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009799tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9800 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9802 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009803 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009804 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9805 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009806
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009807 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009808
9809 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9810 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009811 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9812 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9813 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9814 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9815 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9816 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009817
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009818 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9819 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9820 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9821 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009822
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009823 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009824 - accept :
9825 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9826 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9827 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009828
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009829 - reject :
9830 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9831 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9832 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9833 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9834 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9835 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9836 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9837 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9838 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9839 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9840 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009841 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009842
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009843 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9844 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9845 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9846 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9847 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9848 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9849 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9850 hosts.
9851
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009852 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9853 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9854 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9855 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9856 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9857 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9858 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9859 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9860
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009861 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9862 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9863 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9864 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9865 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9866 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9867 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9868 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9869 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009870 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9871 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009872
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009873 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009874 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009875 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9876 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9877 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -05009878 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009879 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9880 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9881 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9882 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9883 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9884 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9885 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9886 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009887
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009888 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009889 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009890 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009891 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009892 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9893 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9894 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009895
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009896 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9897 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9898 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9899 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009900
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009901 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9902 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9903 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9904 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9905 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009906 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9907 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9908 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9909 layer7 information is extracted.
9910
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009911 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9912 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9913 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9914 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9915 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009916
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009917 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9918 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9919 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9920 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9921
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009922 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9923 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9924 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9925 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9926
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009927 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9928 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9929 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9930 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9931 continues.
9932
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009933 - set-src <expr> :
9934 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9935 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9936 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009937 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009938
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009939 Arguments:
9940 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9941 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009942
9943 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009944 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9945
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009946 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9947 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009948
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009949 - set-src-port <expr> :
9950 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9951 expression.
9952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009953 Arguments:
9954 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9955 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009956
9957 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009958 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9959
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009960 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9961 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9962 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009963
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009964 - set-dst <expr> :
9965 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9966 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9967 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9968 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9969 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9970
9971 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9972 followed by some converters.
9973
9974 Example:
9975
9976 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9977 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9978
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009979 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9980 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9981
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009982 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9983 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9984 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9985 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9986
9987
9988 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9989 followed by some converters.
9990
9991 Example:
9992
9993 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9994
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009995 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9996 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9997 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9998
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009999 - "silent-drop" :
10000 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010001 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010002 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10003 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10004 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10005 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10006 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010007 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10008 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010009 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10010 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010011 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010012 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10013 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10014 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10015 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10016
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010017 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10018 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10019 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010020
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010021 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10022 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10023 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010024
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010025 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010026 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010027 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010029 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10030 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10031 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010032
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010033 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010034 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10035 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010036
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010037 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10038
10039 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10040
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010041 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10042
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010043 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010044
10045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010046tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10047 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010049 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010050 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010051 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10052 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010054 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010055
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010056 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010057 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10058 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10059 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10060 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010062 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10063 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10064 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10065 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010066 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10067 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10068 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10069 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10070 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10071 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010072 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010073 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010075 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10076 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10077 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10078 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010079
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010080 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010081 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010082 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010083 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10084 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010085 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010086 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010087 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010088 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +020010089 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010090 - set-dst <expr>
10091 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010092 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010093 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010094 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010095 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010096
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010097 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10098 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010099 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10100 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010101
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010102 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10103 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10104 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10105 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10106 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10107 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010108
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010109 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010110 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10111 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010113 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010114 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10115 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10116 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10117 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010118 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
10119 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
10120 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010121
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010122 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010123 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
10124 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
10125 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010126
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010127 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
10128 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
10129
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010130 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010131 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
10132 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010133
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010134 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10135 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010136 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010139 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010141 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010142 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10143 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010144 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010145 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10146 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010147
10148 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10149 followed by some converters.
10150
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010151 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10152 <var-name>.
10153
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010154 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
10155 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
10156 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
10157 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
10158 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
10159
10160 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
10161 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
10162 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
10163 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
10164 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
10165 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
10166 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
10167 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
10168 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
10169 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
10170 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
10171
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010172 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10173 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10174 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10175 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10176 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10177
10178 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10179
10180 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10181
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010182 Example:
10183
10184 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010185 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010186
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010187 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010188 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
10189 # and reject everything else.
10190 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
10191 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010192 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010193 tcp-request content reject
10194
10195 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010196 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
10197 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10198 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010199 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010200
10201 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
10202 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
10203 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010204 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010205 tcp-request content reject
10206
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010207 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010208 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010209 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010210 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010211 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
10212 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010213
10214 Example:
10215 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10216 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020010217 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010218
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010219 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010220 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010221
10222 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010223 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010224 # protecting all our sites
10225 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010226 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10227 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010228 ...
10229 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
10230
10231 backend http_dynamic
10232 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010233 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010234 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010235 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010236 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010237 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010238 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010240 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010241
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030010242 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
10243 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010244
10245
10246tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
10247 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010249 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010250 Arguments :
10251 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10252 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10253 as explained at the top of this document.
10254
10255 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
10256 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
10257 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
10258 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
10259 data for at most the specified amount of time.
10260
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010261 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
10262 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
10263 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
10264 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
10265
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010266 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
10267 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010268 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010269 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010010270 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
10271 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
10272 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
10273 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010274
10275 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
10276 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
10277 it pass through unaffected.
10278
10279 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
10280 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
10281 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010282 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010283 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
10284 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020010285 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
10286 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
10287 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010288
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010289 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010290 "timeout client".
10291
10292
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010293tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10294 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
10295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10296 no | no | yes | yes
10297 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010298 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10299 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010300
10301 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10302
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010303 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010304 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10305 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010306 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
10307 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010308
10309 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
10310
10311 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10312 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10313 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10314 inserted.
10315
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010316 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010317 - accept :
10318 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10319 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10320 the rules evaluation.
10321
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010322 - close :
10323 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
10324 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
10325 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
10326 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
10327 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
10328 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010329 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020010330 protocols.
10331
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010332 - reject :
10333 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10334 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010335 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010336
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010337 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10338 Sets a variable.
10339
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010340 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10341 Unsets a variable.
10342
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010343 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10344 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10345 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10346 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10347
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010348 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10349 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10350 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10351 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10352
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010353 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10354 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10355 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10356 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10357 continues.
10358
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010359 - "silent-drop" :
10360 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010361 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010362 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10363 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10364 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10365 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10366 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010367 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10368 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010369 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10370 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010372 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10373 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10374 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10375 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10376
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010377 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10378 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10379
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010380 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10381 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10382 for changing the default action to a reject.
10383
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010384 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10385 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10386 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10387 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010388 period.
10389
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010390 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10391 declared inline.
10392
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010393 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10394 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010395 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010396 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10397 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010398 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010399 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010400 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010401 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10402 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010403 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010404 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10405 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010406
10407 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10408 followed by some converters.
10409
10410 Example:
10411
10412 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10413
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010414 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10415 <var-name>.
10416
10417 Example:
10418
10419 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10420
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010421 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10422 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10423 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10424 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10425 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10426
10427 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10428
10429 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10430
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010431 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10432
10433 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10434
10435
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010436tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10437 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10439 no | yes | yes | no
10440 Arguments :
10441 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10442 below.
10443
10444 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10445
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010446 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010447 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10448 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10449 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10450 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10451 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10452 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10453 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010454 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010455 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10456 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10457 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10458 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10459 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10460 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10461 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10462 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10463 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10464 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10465 instead.
10466
10467 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10468 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10469 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10470 rules which may be inserted.
10471
10472 Several types of actions are supported :
10473 - accept : the request is accepted
10474 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10475 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10476 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010477 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010478 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10479 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010480 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010481 - silent-drop
10482
10483 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10484 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10485 sections for a complete description.
10486
10487 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10488 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10489 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10490
10491 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10492 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10493 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10494 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10495 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10496
10497 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10498 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10499
10500 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10501 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10502 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10503
10504 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10505 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10506 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10507
10508 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10509 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10510 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10511
10512 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10513 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10514 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10515
10516 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10517
10518 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10519
10520
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010521tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10522 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10524 no | no | yes | yes
10525 Arguments :
10526 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10527 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10528 as explained at the top of this document.
10529
10530 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10531
10532
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010533timeout check <timeout>
10534 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10535 established.
10536
10537 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10538 yes | no | yes | yes
10539 Arguments:
10540 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10541 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10542 as explained at the top of this document.
10543
10544 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10545 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010546 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010547 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010548 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10549 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10550 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010551
10552 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10553 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10554
10555 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10556 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010557 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010558
10559 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10560 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10561 forget about it.
10562
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010563 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10564 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010565
10566
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010567timeout client <timeout>
10568timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10569 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10571 yes | yes | yes | no
10572 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010573 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010574 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10575 as explained at the top of this document.
10576
10577 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10578 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10579 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010580 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10581 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10582 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10583 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010584 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10585 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10586 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010587 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010588 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010589 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10590 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010591 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10592 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010593
10594 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10595 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10596 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10597 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010598 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010599 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10600
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010601 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010602
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010603 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10604 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10605 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10606
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010607 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10608 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010609
10610
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010611timeout client-fin <timeout>
10612 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10614 yes | yes | yes | no
10615 Arguments :
10616 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10617 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10618 as explained at the top of this document.
10619
10620 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10621 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10622 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10623 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10624 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10625 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10626 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010627 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10628 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10629 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010630
10631 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10632 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10633 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10634
10635 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10636
10637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010638timeout connect <timeout>
10639timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10640 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10642 yes | no | yes | yes
10643 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010644 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010645 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10646 as explained at the top of this document.
10647
10648 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010649 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010650 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010651 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010652 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10653 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010654
10655 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10656 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10657 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10658 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010659 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010660 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10661
10662 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10663 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10664 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10665
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010666 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10667 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010668
10669
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010670timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10671 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10673 yes | yes | yes | yes
10674 Arguments :
10675 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10676 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10677 as explained at the top of this document.
10678
10679 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10680 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10681 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10682 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10683 once the request has started to present itself.
10684
10685 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10686 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10687 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10688 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10689 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10690
10691 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10692 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10693 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10694 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10695
10696 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10697 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010698 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010699 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10700 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010701 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010702
10703 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10704 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10705 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10706 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10707
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010708 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10709 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010710 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10711
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010712 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10713
10714
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010715timeout http-request <timeout>
10716 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010719 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010720 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10722 as explained at the top of this document.
10723
10724 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10725 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10726 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10727 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10728 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10729 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10730 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010731 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10732 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10733 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10734 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010735 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010736 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10737 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010738
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010739 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10740 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10741 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10742 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10743 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010744 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010745
10746 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10747 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010748 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010749 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10750 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10751
10752 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010753 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10754 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10755 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010756
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010757 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010758 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010759
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010760
10761timeout queue <timeout>
10762 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10764 yes | no | yes | yes
10765 Arguments :
10766 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10768 as explained at the top of this document.
10769
10770 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10771 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10772 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10773 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10774 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10775
10776 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10777 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10778 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10779 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10780
10781 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10782
10783
10784timeout server <timeout>
10785timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10786 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10788 yes | no | yes | yes
10789 Arguments :
10790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10792 as explained at the top of this document.
10793
10794 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10795 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10796 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10797 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10798 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10799 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10800 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10801
10802 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10803 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10804 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10805 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10806 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010807 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010808 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010809 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10810 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010811 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10812 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010813
10814 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10815 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10816 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10817 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010818 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010819 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10820
10821 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10822 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10823 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10824
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010825 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010826
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010827
10828timeout server-fin <timeout>
10829 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10831 yes | no | yes | yes
10832 Arguments :
10833 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10834 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10835 as explained at the top of this document.
10836
10837 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10838 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10839 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10840 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10841 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10842 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10843 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10844 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10845 situations, it should not be needed.
10846
10847 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10848 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10849 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10850
10851 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10852
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010853
10854timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010855 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10857 yes | yes | yes | yes
10858 Arguments :
10859 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10860 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10861 as explained at the top of this document.
10862
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010863 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10864 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10865 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10866 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010867
10868 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10869 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10870 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10871 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010872 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010873
10874 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10875
10876
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010877timeout tunnel <timeout>
10878 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10880 yes | no | yes | yes
10881 Arguments :
10882 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10883 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10884 as explained at the top of this document.
10885
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010886 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010887 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10888 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10889 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010890 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10891 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010892 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10893 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10894 specified.
10895
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010896 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10897 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10898 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10899 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10900 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10901 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10902 state.
10903
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010904 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10905 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10906 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10907 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010908 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010909
10910 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10911 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10912 forget about it.
10913
10914 Example :
10915 defaults http
10916 option http-server-close
10917 timeout connect 5s
10918 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010919 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010920 timeout server 30s
10921 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10922
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010923 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010924
10925
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010926transparent (deprecated)
10927 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010929 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010930 Arguments : none
10931
10932 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10933 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10934 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10935 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10936 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10937 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10938 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10939 appropriate server.
10940
10941 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10942
10943 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10944 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10945
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010946 See also: "option transparent"
10947
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010948unique-id-format <string>
10949 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10951 yes | yes | yes | no
10952 Arguments :
10953 <string> is a log-format string.
10954
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010955 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10956 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10957 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10958 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010959
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010960 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10961 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10962 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10963 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10964 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10965 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10966 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10967 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010968
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010969 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10970 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010971
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010972 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010973
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010974 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010975
10976 will generate:
10977
10978 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10979
10980 See also: "unique-id-header"
10981
10982unique-id-header <name>
10983 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10985 yes | yes | yes | no
10986 Arguments :
10987 <name> is the name of the header.
10988
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010989 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10990 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010991
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010992 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010993
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010994 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010995 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10996
10997 will generate:
10998
10999 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11000
11001 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011002
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011003use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011004 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11006 no | yes | yes | no
11007 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011008 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11009 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011010
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011011 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11012 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011013
11014 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11015 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11016 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011017 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011018 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011019 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11020 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011021
11022 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11023 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11024 assign the backend.
11025
11026 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11027 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11028 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11029 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11030 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11031 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11032
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011033 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011034 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011035 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11036 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11037 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11038
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011039 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11040 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11041 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11042 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11043 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11044 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11045 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11046 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11047 cannot be forced from the request.
11048
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011049 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011050 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11051 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11052
11053 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11054 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011055
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011056
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011057use-server <server> if <condition>
11058use-server <server> unless <condition>
11059 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11061 no | no | yes | yes
11062 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011063 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011064
11065 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11066
11067 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11068 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11069 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11070
11071 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11072 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11073 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11074 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11075 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11076 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11077 matches will assign the server.
11078
11079 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11080 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11081 with the next rules until one matches.
11082
11083 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11084 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11085 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11086 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11087
11088 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11089 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11090 stripped.
11091
11092 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11093 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11094 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11095 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11096
11097 Example :
11098 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11099 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11100 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11101 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11102 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11103 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011104 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011105 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11106 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11107
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011108 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011110
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100111115. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011112--------------------------
11113
11114The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
11115depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
11116settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
11117written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
11118described in this section.
11119
11120
111215.1. Bind options
11122-----------------
11123
11124The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
11125as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
11126no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
11127parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
11128while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
11129provided immediately after the setting name.
11130
11131The currently supported settings are the following ones.
11132
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011133accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
11134 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
11135 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
11136 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
11137 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
11138 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
11139 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
11140 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
11141 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
11142 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011143 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
11144 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
11145 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011146
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011147accept-proxy
11148 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020011149 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
11150 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011151 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
11152 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
11153 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
11154 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011155 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011156 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
11157 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011158 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
11159 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011160
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011161allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010011162 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011163 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011164 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010011165 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
11166 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020011167
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011168alpn <protocols>
11169 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11170 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11171 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011172 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011173 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011174 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
11175 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11176 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
11177 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
11178 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
11179 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
11180 preference, like below :
11181
11182 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011184backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010011185 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011186 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
11187
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010011188curves <curves>
11189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11190 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
11191 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
11192 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
11193 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
11194 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
11195
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011196ecdhe <named curve>
11197 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010011198 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
11199 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020011200
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011201ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011202 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11203 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11204 client's certificate.
11205
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011206ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
11207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11208 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
11209 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
11210 error is ignored.
11211
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011212ca-sign-file <cafile>
11213 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11214 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
11215 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
11216 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11217 'generate-certificates' for details.
11218
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000011219ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011220 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
11221 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
11222 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
11223 'generate-certificates' for details.
11224
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011225ciphers <ciphers>
11226 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
11227 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000011228 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011229 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011230 information and recommendations see e.g.
11231 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
11232 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
11233 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
11234
11235ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11237 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
11238 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
11239 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000011240 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
11241 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011242
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011243crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11245 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11246 to verify client's certificate.
11247
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11250 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
11251 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
11252 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
11253 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
11254 file.
11255
11256 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
11257 are loaded.
11258
11259 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011260 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011261 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
11262 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
11263 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
11264 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011265 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
11266 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011267 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011268
11269 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
11270 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
11271 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
11272 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010011273 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
11274 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011275
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020011276 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011277
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011278 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011279 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011280 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
11281 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011282 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
11283 clients).
11284
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020011285 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
11286 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
11287 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
11288 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
11289 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
11290 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
11291 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
11292 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
11293 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
11294 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
11295 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
11296 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
11297 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
11298
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010011299 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
11300 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
11301 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
11302 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
11303 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
11304
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011305 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
11306 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
11307 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
11308 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011309
11310 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
11311 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
11312 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
11313 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
11314 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
11315 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
11316 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
11317 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
11318 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
11319
11320 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
11321
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011322 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011323 a cert bundle.
11324
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011325 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011326 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11327 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11328 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11329 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11330 provide multi-cert support.
11331
11332 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11333
11334 Filename | CN | SAN
11335 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11336 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011337 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011338 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11339 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11340
11341 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11342 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11343 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11344 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011345 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11346 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11347 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011348
11349 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11350 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11351
11352 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11353 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11354 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11355
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011356crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011358 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011359 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011360 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011361
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011362crt-list <file>
11363 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011364 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11365 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011366
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011367 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11368
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011369 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11370 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011371 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011372 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011373
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011374 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11375 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11376 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11377 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11378 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11379 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11380 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11381 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011382
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011383 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011384 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011385 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11386 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11387 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011388
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011389 crt-list file example:
11390 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011391 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011392 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011393 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011394
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011395defer-accept
11396 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11397 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11398 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011400 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11401 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11402 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11403 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11404 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11405 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11406 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11407
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011408expose-fd listeners
11409 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11410 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011411 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11412 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011413 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011414
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011415force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011416 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011417 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011418 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011419 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011420
11421force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011422 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011423 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011424 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011425
11426force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011427 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011428 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011429 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011430
11431force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011432 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011433 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011434 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011435
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011436force-tlsv13
11437 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11438 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011439 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011440
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011441generate-certificates
11442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11443 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11444 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11445 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11446 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11447 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11448 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11449 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11450 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11451 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11452 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11453
11454 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11455 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011456 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011457 certificate is used many times.
11458
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011459gid <gid>
11460 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11461 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11462 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11463 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11464 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11465
11466group <group>
11467 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11468 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11469 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11470 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11471 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11472
11473id <id>
11474 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11475 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11476 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11477 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11478
11479interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011480 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11481 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11482 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11483 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11484 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11485 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011486 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11487 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11488 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11489 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11490 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11491 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011492
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011493level <level>
11494 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11495 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11496 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011497 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011498 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11499 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11500 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011501 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011502 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011503 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011504 all counters).
11505
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011506severity-output <format>
11507 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11508 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11509 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11510 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11511 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11512 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11513 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11514 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11515 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11516 rfc5424 convention.
11517
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011518maxconn <maxconn>
11519 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11520 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11521 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11522 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11523 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11524 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11525 eat all memory.
11526
11527mode <mode>
11528 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11529 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11530 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11531 UNIX sockets.
11532
11533mss <maxseg>
11534 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11535 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11536 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11537 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11538 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11539 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11540 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11541 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11542 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11543 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11544 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11545
11546name <name>
11547 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11548 page.
11549
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011550namespace <name>
11551 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11552 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11553 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11554 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11555
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011556nice <nice>
11557 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11558 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11559 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11560 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11561 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11562 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11563 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11564 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11565 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11566 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11567 one for an RDP socket.
11568
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011569no-ca-names
11570 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11571 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11572
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011573no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011574 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011575 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011576 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011577 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011578 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11579 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011580
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011581no-tls-tickets
11582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11583 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11584 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011585 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11586 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011587
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011588no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011590 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011591 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011592 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011593 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11594 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011595
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011596no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011597 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011598 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011599 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011600 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011601 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11602 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011603
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011604no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011606 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011607 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011608 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011609 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11610 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011611
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011612no-tlsv13
11613 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11614 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11615 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11616 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011617 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11618 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011619
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011620npn <protocols>
11621 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11622 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11623 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011624 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011625 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011626 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11627 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11628 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11629 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11630 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011631
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011632prefer-client-ciphers
11633 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11634 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11635 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011636 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11637 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11638 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011639
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011640process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011641 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011642 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011643 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011644 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11645 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11646 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11647 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011648 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010011649 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
11650 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
11651 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
11652 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
11653 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011654
11655 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11656
11657 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11658 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11659 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11660 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11661 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11662 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11663 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11664 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011665
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011666proto <name>
11667 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11668 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11669 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11670 in haproxy -vv.
11671 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11672 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011673 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011674 h2" on the bind line.
11675
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011676ssl
11677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011678 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011679 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11680 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011681 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11682 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011683
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011684ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11685 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11686 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11687 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11688
11689ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11690 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11691 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11692 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11693
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011694strict-sni
11695 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11696 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11697 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11698 See the "crt" option for more information.
11699
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011700tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011701 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011702 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11703 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011704 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011705 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11706 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11707 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11708 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11709 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11710 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11711 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11712
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011713tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011714 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011715 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11716 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11717 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11718 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11719 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11720 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11721 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011722 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11723 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11724 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011725
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011726tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11727 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011728 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11729 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11730 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11731 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11732 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11733 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11734 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11735 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11736 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11737 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011738 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11739 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11740
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011741transparent
11742 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11743 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11744 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11745 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11746 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11747 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11748 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11749 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11750 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11751 so check for support with your vendor.
11752
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011753v4v6
11754 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11755 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11756 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11757 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011758 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011759
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011760v6only
11761 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11762 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11763 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011764 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11765 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011766
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011767uid <uid>
11768 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11769 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11770 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11771 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11772 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11773
11774user <user>
11775 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11776 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11777 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11778 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11779 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11780
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011781verify [none|optional|required]
11782 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11783 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11784 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11785 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11786 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011787 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11788 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11789 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11790 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011791
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200117925.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011793------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011794
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011795The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11796which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11797arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11798settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11799after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11800Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11801address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011803 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011804 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011805
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011806Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11807keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011809The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011810
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011811addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011812 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011813 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11814 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11815 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11816 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11817 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011818
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011819agent-check
11820 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011821 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011822 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11823 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11824 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011825
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011826 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011827 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011828 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11829 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11830 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011831
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011832 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11833 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11834 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11835 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11836 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011837
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011838 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011839 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011840
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011841 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11842 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11843 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011844
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011845 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11846 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11847 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011848
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011849 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11850 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11851 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11852 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11853 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011854 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011855 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011856
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011857 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11858 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011859
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011860 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11861 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11862 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11863 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11864 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11865 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11866 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11867 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11868 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011869
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011870 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11871 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011872 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11873 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11874 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011875 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011876
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011877 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011878 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011879
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011880agent-send <string>
11881 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11882 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11883 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11884 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11885 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11886
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011887agent-inter <delay>
11888 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11889 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11890
11891 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11892 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11893 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11894 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11895 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11896 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11897 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11898 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11899 of backends use the same servers.
11900
11901 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11902
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011903agent-addr <addr>
11904 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11905
11906 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11907 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11908 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11909 hostname, it will be resolved.
11910
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011911agent-port <port>
11912 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11913
11914 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11915
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011916allow-0rtt
11917 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020011918 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
11919 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020011920
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011921alpn <protocols>
11922 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11923 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11924 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011925 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011926 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11927 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11928 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11929 now obsolete NPN extension.
11930 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11931 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11932
11933 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011935backup
11936 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11937 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11938 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11939 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011940 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11941 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011942
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011943ca-file <cafile>
11944 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11945 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11946 server's certificate.
11947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011948check
11949 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011950 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11951 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11952 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11953 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11954 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11955 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11956 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011957 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11958 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011959 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11960 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011961
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011962check-send-proxy
11963 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11964 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11965 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11966 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11967 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11968 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11969 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11970
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011971check-alpn <protocols>
11972 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11973 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11974 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11975
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011976check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011977 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011978 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11979 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011980
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011981check-ssl
11982 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11983 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11984 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11985 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011986 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011987 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11988 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011989 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011990 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11991 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011992
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011993check-via-socks4
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011994 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080011995 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
11996 for normal traffic.
11997
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011998ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011999 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12000 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12001 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012002 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12003 information and recommendations see e.g.
12004 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12005 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12006 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012007
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012008ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12010 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12011 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12012 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012013 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12014 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12015 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012017cookie <value>
12018 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12019 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12020 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12021 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12022 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12023 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12024 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12025
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012026crl-file <crlfile>
12027 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12028 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12029 to verify server's certificate.
12030
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012031crt <cert>
12032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12033 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12034 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12035 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12036 certificate request.
12037
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012038disabled
12039 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12040 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12041 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12042 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
12043 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012044 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012045
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012046enabled
12047 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
12048 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
12049 default value.
12050 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
12051 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012052
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012053error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010012054 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
12055 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
12056 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012058 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012059
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012060fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012061 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
12062 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
12063 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
12064
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012065force-sslv3
12066 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12067 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012068 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012069 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012070
12071force-tlsv10
12072 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012073 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012074 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012075
12076force-tlsv11
12077 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012078 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012079 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012080
12081force-tlsv12
12082 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012083 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012084 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012085
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012086force-tlsv13
12087 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
12088 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012089 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012090
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012091id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020012092 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
12093 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
12094 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012096init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
12097 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
12098 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012099 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012100 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
12101 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
12102 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
12103 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
12104 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
12105 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
12106 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
12107 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
12108 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012109 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012110 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
12111 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
12112 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
12113 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
12114 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
12115 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012116 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010012117
12118 Example:
12119 defaults
12120 # never fail on address resolution
12121 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
12122
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012123inter <delay>
12124fastinter <delay>
12125downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012126 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
12127 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12128 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
12129 between checks depending on the server state :
12130
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020012131 Server state | Interval used
12132 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12133 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
12134 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12135 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
12136 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
12137 or yet unchecked. |
12138 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
12139 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
12140 | "inter" otherwise.
12141 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012143 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
12144 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
12145 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
12146 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012147 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12148 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12149 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12150 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12151 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012153maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012154 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
12155 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
12156 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
12157 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
12158 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
12159 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
12160 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
12161 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
12162
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012163maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012164 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
12165 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
12166 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
12167 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
12168 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
12169 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
12170 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
12171
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010012172max-reuse <count>
12173 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
12174 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
12175 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
12176 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
12177 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
12178 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
12179 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
12180 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
12181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012182minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012183 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
12184 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
12185 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
12186 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
12187 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
12188 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012189 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012190 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012191
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012192namespace <name>
12193 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12194 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
12195 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12196 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12197
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012198no-agent-check
12199 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
12200 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12201 default value.
12202 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12203 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
12204
12205no-backup
12206 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
12207 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12208 default value.
12209 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12210 "default-server" "backup" setting.
12211
12212no-check
12213 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
12214 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12215 default value.
12216 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12217 "default-server" "check" setting.
12218
12219no-check-ssl
12220 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
12221 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12222 default value.
12223 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12224 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
12225
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012226no-send-proxy
12227 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
12228 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12229 default value.
12230 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12231 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
12232
12233no-send-proxy-v2
12234 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
12235 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12236 default value.
12237 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12238 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
12239
12240no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
12241 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
12242 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12243 default value.
12244 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12245 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
12246
12247no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12248 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
12249 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12250 default value.
12251 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12252 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
12253
12254no-ssl
12255 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
12256 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12257 default value.
12258 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12259 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
12260
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010012261no-ssl-reuse
12262 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
12263 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
12264 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
12265 and for paranoid users.
12266
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012267no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012268 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12269 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012270 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012271
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012272 Supported in default-server: No
12273
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012274no-tls-tickets
12275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12276 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12277 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012278 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
12279 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012280 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020012281
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012282no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012283 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012284 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12285 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012286 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12287 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012288 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012289
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012290 Supported in default-server: No
12291
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012292no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012293 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012294 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12295 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012296 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12297 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012298 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012299
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012300 Supported in default-server: No
12301
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012302no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020012303 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012304 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12305 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012306 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12307 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012308 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012309
12310 Supported in default-server: No
12311
12312no-tlsv13
12313 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
12314 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
12315 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
12316 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
12317 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012318 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012319
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020012320 Supported in default-server: No
12321
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012322no-verifyhost
12323 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
12324 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12325 default value.
12326 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12327 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012328
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012329no-tfo
12330 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
12331 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12332 default value.
12333 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12334 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
12335
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090012336non-stick
12337 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
12338 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
12339 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
12340
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012341npn <protocols>
12342 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12343 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12344 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012345 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012346 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12347 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12348 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12349
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012350observe <mode>
12351 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12352 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12353 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12354 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12355 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12356 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012357 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012358
12359 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12360
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012361on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012362 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12363 Currently, four modes are available:
12364 - fastinter: force fastinter
12365 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12366 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12367 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12368 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12369
12370 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12371
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012372on-marked-down <action>
12373 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12374 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012375 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12376 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12377 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12378 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12379 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12380 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12381 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12382 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012383
12384 Actions are disabled by default
12385
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012386on-marked-up <action>
12387 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12388 Currently one action is available:
12389 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12390 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12391 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12392 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012393 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12394 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012395 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12396 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12397
12398 Actions are disabled by default
12399
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012400pool-max-conn <max>
12401 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12402 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12403 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12404 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12405 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12406 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12407
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012408pool-purge-delay <delay>
12409 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010012410 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020012411 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012412
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012413port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012414 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12415 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12416 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12417 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12418 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12419 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12420
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012421proto <name>
12422
12423 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12424 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12425 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12426 reported in haproxy -vv.
12427 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12428 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12429
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012430redir <prefix>
12431 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12432 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12433 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12434 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12435 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12436 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12437 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12438 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012439 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012441 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12442 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12443 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12444 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12445
12446 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12447
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012448rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012449 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12450 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12451 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12452
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012453resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12454 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12455 server.
12456
12457 Available options:
12458
12459 * allow-dup-ip
12460 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12461 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12462 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12463 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12464 For such case, simply enable this option.
12465 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12466
12467 * prevent-dup-ip
12468 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12469 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12470 same fqdn.
12471 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12472
12473 Example:
12474 backend b_myapp
12475 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12476 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12477 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12478
12479 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12480 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12481 it
12482 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12483 different address
12484
12485 Default value: not set
12486
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012487resolve-prefer <family>
12488 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12489 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12490 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12491 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12492
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012493 Default value: ipv6
12494
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012495 Example:
12496
12497 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012498
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012499resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012500 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012501 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012502 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012503 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12504 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012505 configured network, another address is selected.
12506
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012507 Example:
12508
12509 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012510
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012511resolvers <id>
12512 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12513 hostname.
12514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012515 Example:
12516
12517 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012518
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012519 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012520
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012521send-proxy
12522 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12523 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12524 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12525 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012526 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12527 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12528 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12529 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12530 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12531 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12532 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12533 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12534 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12535 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012536 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12537 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012538
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012539send-proxy-v2
12540 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12541 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12542 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12543 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012544 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12545 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12546 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12547 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012548
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012549proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12550 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12551 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012552 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12553 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012554 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12555 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012556 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012557
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012558send-proxy-v2-ssl
12559 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12560 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12561 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12562 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12563 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12564 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12565 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012566 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12567 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012568
12569send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12570 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12571 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12572 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12573 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12574 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12575 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12576 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12577 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012578 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12579 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012580
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012581slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012582 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12583 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12584 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12585 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12586 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12587 parameters :
12588
12589 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12590 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12591
12592 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12593 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12594 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12595 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12596
12597 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12598 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12599 seen as failed.
12600
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012601sni <expression>
12602 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12603 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12604 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12605 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012606 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12607 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012608 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012609 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12610 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012611
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012612source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012613source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012614source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012615 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12616 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12617 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12618 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12619
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012620 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12621 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12622 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12623 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12624 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12625 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12626 server.
12627
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012628 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12629 specifying the source address without port(s).
12630
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012631ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012632 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12633 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12634 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12635 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12636 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12637 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012638 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12639 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012640
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012641ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12642 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12643 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12644 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12645
12646ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12647 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12648 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12649 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12650
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012651ssl-reuse
12652 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12653 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12654 default value.
12655 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12656 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12657
12658stick
12659 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12660 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12661 default value.
12662 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12663 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012664
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012665socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012666 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012667 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
12668 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
12669
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012670tcp-ut <delay>
12671 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12672 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12673 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012674 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012675 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12676 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12677 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12678 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12679 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12680 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12681 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12682 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12683 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12684
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012685tfo
12686 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
12687 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
12688 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
12689 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
12690 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécailleaeeb1c92019-07-04 14:19:06 +020012691 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010012692
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012694 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12695 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12696 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12697 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012698 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12699
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012700tls-tickets
12701 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12702 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12703 default value.
12704 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12705 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012706
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012707verify [none|required]
12708 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012709 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012710 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12711 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012712 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012713 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12714 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12715 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12716 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12717 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12718 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12719 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12720 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012721
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012722verifyhost <hostname>
12723 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012724 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12725 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12726 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12727 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12728 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12729 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12730 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12731 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012732
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012733weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012734 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12735 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12736 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012737 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12738 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12739 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12740 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12741 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12742 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012743
12744
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127455.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12746-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012747
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012748HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12749using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12750configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012751This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12752can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12753workload.
12754This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12755resolution at run time.
12756Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12757carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12758
12759
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127605.3.1. Global overview
12761----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012762
12763As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12764different steps of the process life:
12765
12766 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12767 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12768 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12769
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012770 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12771 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012772
12773A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12774 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12775 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12776 resolution to know this new IP.
12777
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012778When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012779HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012780SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12781from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12782will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12783will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012784
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012785A few things important to notice:
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012786 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012787 first valid response.
12788
12789 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12790 servers return an error.
12791
12792
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200127935.3.2. The resolvers section
12794----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012795
12796This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012797HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12798contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012799
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012800When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12801uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12802is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12803answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12804
12805When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012806used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012807
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012808 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12809 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12810 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012811
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012812 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12813 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012814
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012815 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12816 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12817 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012818
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012819For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12820following scenarios are possible:
12821
12822 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12823 ignored
12824
12825 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12826 applied
12827
12828 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12829 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12830
12831 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12832 retries the query with a new type
12833
12834 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12835 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012836
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012837As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12838a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012839<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012840
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012841
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012842resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012843 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012844
12845A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12846
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012847accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012848 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012849 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012850 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12851 by RFC 6891)
12852
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012853 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12854
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012855nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12856 DNS server description:
12857 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12858 <ip> : IP address of the server
12859 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12860
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012861parse-resolv-conf
12862 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12863 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12864 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12865
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012866hold <status> <period>
12867 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12868 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012869 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012870 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012871 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12872 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12873 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12874
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012875 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012876
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012877resolve_retries <nb>
12878 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12879 giving up.
12880 Default value: 3
12881
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012882 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12883 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12884 type.
12885
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012886timeout <event> <time>
12887 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12888 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12889 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012890 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12891 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012892 Default value: 1s
12893 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010012894 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012895 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012896 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12897 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12898
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012899 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012900
12901 resolvers mydns
12902 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12903 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012904 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012905 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012906 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012907 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012908 hold other 30s
12909 hold refused 30s
12910 hold nx 30s
12911 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012912 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012913 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012914
12915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129166. HTTP header manipulation
12917---------------------------
12918
12919In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12920response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12921request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12922which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012923against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012924
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012925If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12926to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12927but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12928HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12929stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12930because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12931a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12932still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012933
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012934This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12935in section 4.2 :
12936
12937 - reqadd <string>
12938 - reqallow <search>
12939 - reqiallow <search>
12940 - reqdel <search>
12941 - reqidel <search>
12942 - reqdeny <search>
12943 - reqideny <search>
12944 - reqpass <search>
12945 - reqipass <search>
12946 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12947 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12948 - reqtarpit <search>
12949 - reqitarpit <search>
12950 - rspadd <string>
12951 - rspdel <search>
12952 - rspidel <search>
12953 - rspdeny <search>
12954 - rspideny <search>
12955 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12956 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12957
12958With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12959is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12960parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12961prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12962Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12963
12964 \t for a tab
12965 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12966 \n for a new line (LF)
12967 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12968 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12969 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12970 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12971 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12972
12973The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12974portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12975above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12976regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
129779 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12978is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12979
12980The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12981after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12982
12983Notes related to these keywords :
12984---------------------------------
12985 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12986 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12987 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12988
12989 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12990 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12991 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12992
12993 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12994 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12995 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12996 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12997 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12998
12999 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
13000 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
13001 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
13002 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
13003 useless headers before adding new ones.
13004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013005 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013006 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
13007
13008 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
13009 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
13010 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
13011
13012 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
13013 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013014 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013015
13016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130177. Using ACLs and fetching samples
13018----------------------------------
13019
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013020HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013021client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
13022The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
13023these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
13024but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
13025data called patterns.
13026
13027
130287.1. ACL basics
13029---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013030
13031The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
13032content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
13033from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
13034simple :
13035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013036 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013037 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013038 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
13039 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013041The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
13042adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013043
13044In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
13045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013046 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013047
13048This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
13049Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
13050and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013051an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
13052conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
13053as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
13054are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013055
13056ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
13057'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
13058which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
13059
13060There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
13061performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
13062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013063The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
13064specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
13065this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013066methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
13067ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013068
13069Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
13070 - boolean
13071 - integer (signed or unsigned)
13072 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
13073 - string
13074 - data block
13075
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013076Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
13077converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
13078would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
13079The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
13080which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
13081
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013082Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
13083keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
13084fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
13085which are summarized in the table below :
13086
13087 +---------------------+-----------------+
13088 | Sample or converter | Default |
13089 | output type | matching method |
13090 +---------------------+-----------------+
13091 | boolean | bool |
13092 +---------------------+-----------------+
13093 | integer | int |
13094 +---------------------+-----------------+
13095 | ip | ip |
13096 +---------------------+-----------------+
13097 | string | str |
13098 +---------------------+-----------------+
13099 | binary | none, use "-m" |
13100 +---------------------+-----------------+
13101
13102Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
13103matching method, see below.
13104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013105The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
13106 - boolean
13107 - integer or integer range
13108 - IP address / network
13109 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
13110 - regular expression
13111 - hex block
13112
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013113The following ACL flags are currently supported :
13114
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013115 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
13116 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013117 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013118 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013119 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013120 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013121 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
13122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013123The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
13124read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
13125if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
13126lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
13127will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
13128beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
13129a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
13130lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
13131exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
13132
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010013133The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
13134parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
13135ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
13136a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
13137check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
13138
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010013139The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
13140socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
13141file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
13142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013143Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
13144loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
13145
13146 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
13147
13148In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
13149the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
13150case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
13151as well.
13152
13153The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
13154sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
13155do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
13156methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
13157is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013158obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
13160default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
13161that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
13162string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
13163
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013164The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
13165By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
13166string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
13167resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
13168server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013169waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010013170flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
13171function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
13172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013173There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
13174sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
13175be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013176
13177 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
13178 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013179 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
13180 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
13181 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
13182 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013183
13184 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
13185 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013186 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013187
13188 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013189 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013190
13191 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013192 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013193
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013194 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013195 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
13196
13197 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
13198 binary or string samples.
13199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013200 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
13201 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013203 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
13204 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
13205 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013207 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
13208 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013210 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
13211 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
13214 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013216 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
13217 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013218 This may be used with binary or string samples.
13219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013220 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
13221 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
13222 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020013223
13224For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
13225request, it is possible to do :
13226
13227 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
13228
13229In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
13230buffer, one would use the following acl :
13231
13232 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
13233
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013234On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
13235possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
13236
13237 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
13238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013239All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
13240criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
13241method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
13242to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
13243criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
13244the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013246If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013247the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
13248For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
13251 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
13252 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
13253 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013254
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020013255
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013256The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
13257types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
13258combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
13259brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
13260default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013262 +-------------------------------------------------+
13263 | Input sample type |
13264 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013265 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13267 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
13268 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013269 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013271 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013273 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013275 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020013277 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013279 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013281 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013282 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013283 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013285 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013286 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013287 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010013289 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013290 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
13291 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
13292 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013293
13294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200132957.1.1. Matching booleans
13296------------------------
13297
13298In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
13299Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
13300When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
13301that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
13302
13303Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
13304return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
13305"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
13306
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133087.1.2. Matching integers
13309------------------------
13310
13311Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
13312enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
13313to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
13314
13315Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
13316matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
13317lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013318
13319For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
13320unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
13321representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
13322
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013323As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
13324two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
13325instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
13326ranges and operators.
13327
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013328For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013329operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
13330Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
13331of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013332
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013333Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013334
13335 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
13336 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
13337 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
13338 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
13339 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
13340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013341For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013342
13343 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
13344
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013345This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
13346
13347 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
13348
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133507.1.3. Matching strings
13351-----------------------
13352
13353String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13354different forms :
13355
13356 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013357 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013358
13359 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013360 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361
13362 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13363 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13364
13365 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13366 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13367
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013368 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013369 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13370 matches.
13371
13372 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13373 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13374 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013375
13376String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13377exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13378characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13379string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13380to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013381before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013382
13383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133847.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13385---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013386
13387Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13388they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13389possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13390passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13391the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013392the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13393match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013394
13395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200133967.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13397-------------------------------------
13398
13399It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13400not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13401a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13402to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13403digits may be used upper or lower case.
13404
13405Example :
13406 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13407 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13408
13409
134107.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13411---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013412
13413IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13414netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13415within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013416host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013417difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13418at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13419does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13420parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013421
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013422The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13423abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13424
13425 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13426 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13427 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13428 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13429 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13430 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13431 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13432 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13433
13434Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13435192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13436
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013437IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13438Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13439trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13440IPv6 patterns.
13441
13442HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13443following situations :
13444 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13445 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13446 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13447 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13448 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13449 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13450 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13451 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13452 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13453 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455
134567.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13457----------------------------------
13458
13459Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13460combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13461
13462 - AND (implicit)
13463 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13464 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013466A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013467
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013468 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13471indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013472
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013473For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13474"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13475requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13476is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13477
13478 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013479 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13480 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13481 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013482
13483To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13484and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13485
13486 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13487 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13488 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13489 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13490
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013491 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013492 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13493 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13494 use_backend www if host_www
13495
13496It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13497expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13498be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13499the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13500
13501 The following rule :
13502
13503 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013504 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505
13506 Can also be written that way :
13507
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013508 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013509
13510It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13511to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13512simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13513sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13514good use is the following :
13515
13516 With named ACLs :
13517
13518 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13519 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13520 monitor fail if site_dead
13521
13522 With anonymous ACLs :
13523
13524 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13525
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013526See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13527keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013528
13529
135307.3. Fetching samples
13531---------------------
13532
13533Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13534against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13535sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13536ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13537of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13538available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13539
13540This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13541Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13542compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13543deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13544
13545The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13546matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13547method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13548indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13549
13550As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13551when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13552mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13553the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13554ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13555
13556Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13557multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13558when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013559incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13560are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013561is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13562all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13563
13564Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13565 - name
13566 - name(arg1)
13567 - name(arg1,arg2)
13568
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013569
135707.3.1. Converters
13571-----------------
13572
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013573Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13574of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13575is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13576was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013578unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13579
13580These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13581sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13582the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013583support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013584
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013585A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13586support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13587supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13588(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13589bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013591The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013592
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001359351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13594 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13595 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13596 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13597 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13598 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13599
13600 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013601 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13602 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013603 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13604 frontend http-in
13605 bind *:8081
13606 default_backend servers
13607 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13608 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13609
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013610add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013611 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013612 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013613 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13614 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013615 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013616 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13617 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13618 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13619 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013620 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013621 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013622
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010013623aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
13624 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
13625 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
13626 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
13627 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
13628 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
13629 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
13630
13631 Example:
13632 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
13633 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
13634
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013635and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013636 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013637 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013638 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13639 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013640 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013641 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13642 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13643 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13644 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013645 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013646 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013647
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013648b64dec
13649 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13650 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13651
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013652base64
13653 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013654 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013655 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13656
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013657bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013658 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013659 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013661 presence of a flag).
13662
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013663bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13664 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13665 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013666 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013667
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013668concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13669 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13670 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13671 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13672 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13673 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13674 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13675 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13676 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13677 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13678 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013679 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. Note that due to the config
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013680 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013681 delimiters.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013682
13683 Example:
13684 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13685 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13686 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13687 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13688
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013689cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013690 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13691 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013692
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013693crc32([<avalanche>])
13694 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13695 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13696 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13697 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13698 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13699 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13700 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13701 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13702 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13703 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013704 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13705
13706crc32c([<avalanche>])
13707 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13708 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13709 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13710 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13711 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13712 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13713 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13714 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013715
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013716da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013717 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13718 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13719 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13720 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013721 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013722 configuration language.
13723
13724 Example:
13725 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013726 bind *:8881
13727 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013728 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013729
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013730debug
13731 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13732 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13733 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13734
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013735div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013736 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13737 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013738 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013739 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13740 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013741 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013742 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13743 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13744 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13745 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013746 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013747 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013748
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013749djb2([<avalanche>])
13750 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13751 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13752 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13753 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13754 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13755 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13756 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013757 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13758 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013759
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013760even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013761 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013762 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13763
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013764field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13765 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13766 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13767 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13768 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13769 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13770 fields.
13771
13772 Example :
13773 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13774 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13775 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13776 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13777 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013778
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013779hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013781 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013782 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013783 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013784
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013785hex2i
13786 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013787 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013788
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013789http_date([<offset>])
13790 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13791 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13792 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13793 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13794 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13795 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013796
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013797in_table(<table>)
13798 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13799 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13800 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013801 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013802 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13803
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013804ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13805 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013806 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013807 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13808 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13809 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13810 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13811 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013812
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013813json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013814 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013815 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013816 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013817 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13818 of errors:
13819 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13820 bytes, ...)
13821 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13822 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13823
13824 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13825 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13826 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13827 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13828 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13829 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013830 - "ascii" : never fails;
13831 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13832 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013833 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013834 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013835 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13836 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13837
13838 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013839 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013840
13841 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013842 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013843 capture request header user-agent len 150
13844 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013845
13846 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13847 GET / HTTP/1.0
13848 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13849
13850 Output log:
13851 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013853language(<value>[,<default>])
13854 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13855 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13856 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13857 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13858 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13859 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13860 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13861 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13862 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013863 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013864 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13865 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013866
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013867 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013868
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013869 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13870 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013871
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013872 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13873 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13874 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13875 use_backend spanish if es
13876 use_backend french if fr
13877 use_backend english if en
13878 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013879
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013880length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013881 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13882 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13883 type. The result is of type integer.
13884
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013885lower
13886 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13887 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13888 type. The result is of type string.
13889
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013890ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13891 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13892 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13893 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13894 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13895 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13896 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13897
13898 Example :
13899
13900 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013902 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13903
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013904map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13905map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13906map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13907 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13908 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13909 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13910 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13911 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13912 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13913 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13914 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013915
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013916 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13917 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13918 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013919
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013920 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013921 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013922
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013923 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13924 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13925 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13926 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013927 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13928 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013929 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13930 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13931 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13932 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13933 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13934 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13935 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13936 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013937 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13938 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13939 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013940 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13941 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13942 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13943 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13944 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013945
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013946 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13947 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13948 the corresponding match text.
13949
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013950 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13951 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13952 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13953 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13954 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013955
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013956 Example :
13957
13958 # this is a comment and is ignored
13959 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13960 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13961 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13962 | | | `---------- value
13963 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13964 | `---------------------------- key
13965 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13966
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013967mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013968 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13969 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013970 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013971 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013972 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013973 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13974 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13975 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13976 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013977 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013978 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013979
13980mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013981 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013982 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13983 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013984 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013985 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13989 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13990 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013991 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013992 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013993
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013994nbsrv
13995 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13996 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13997 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13998 map lookup.
13999
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014000neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014001 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
14002 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
14003 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
14004 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014005
14006not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014007 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014008 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014009 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014010 absence of a flag).
14011
14012odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014013 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014014 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
14015
14016or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014017 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014018 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014019 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14020 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014021 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014022 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14023 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14024 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14025 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014026 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014027 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014028
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014029protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
14030 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
14031 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
14032 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
14033 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
14034 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14035 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14036 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14037 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
14038 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
14039 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14040 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
14041
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010014042regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014043 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
14044 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
14045 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
14046 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
14047 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
14048 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
14049 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
14050 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
14051 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
14052 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010014053 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
14054 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
14055 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
14056 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010014057
14058 Example :
14059
14060 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
14061 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
14062 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
14063 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
14064
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014065capture-req(<id>)
14066 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
14067 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14068
14069 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014070 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14071 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014072
14073capture-res(<id>)
14074 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
14075 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
14076
14077 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020014078 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
14079 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020014080
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014081sdbm([<avalanche>])
14082 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
14083 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14084 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14085 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14086 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14087 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14088 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014089 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
14090 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014091
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014092set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014093 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
14094 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
14095 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014096 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014097 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14098 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014099 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014100 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14101 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014102 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014103 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014104
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020014105sha1
14106 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
14107 sample with length of 20 bytes.
14108
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020014109strcmp(<var>)
14110 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
14111 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
14112 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
14113 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
14114 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
14115 shorter).
14116
14117 Example :
14118
14119 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
14120 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
14121 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
14122
14123
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014124sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014125 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
14126 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014127 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014128 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
14129 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014130 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014131 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14132 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014133 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014134 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14135 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014136 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014137 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014138
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014139table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
14140 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14141 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14142 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
14143 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14144 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14145 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
14146
14147
14148table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
14149 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14150 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14151 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
14152 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
14153 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
14154 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
14155
14156table_conn_cnt(<table>)
14157 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14158 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014159 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014160 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
14161 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14162
14163table_conn_cur(<table>)
14164 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14165 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14166 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14167 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14168 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
14169
14170table_conn_rate(<table>)
14171 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14172 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14173 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
14174 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14175 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
14176
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014177table_gpt0(<table>)
14178 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14179 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
14180 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14181 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
14182 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
14183
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014184table_gpc0(<table>)
14185 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14186 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14187 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
14188 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14189 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
14190
14191table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
14192 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14193 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14194 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
14195 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14196 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
14197 sample fetch keyword.
14198
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014199table_gpc1(<table>)
14200 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14201 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14202 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
14203 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
14204 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
14205
14206table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
14207 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14208 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14209 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
14210 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
14211 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
14212 sample fetch keyword.
14213
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014214table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
14215 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14216 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014217 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014218 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
14219 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14220
14221table_http_err_rate(<table>)
14222 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14223 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14224 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
14225 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
14226 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
14227 keyword.
14228
14229table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
14230 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14231 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014232 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014233 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
14234 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
14235
14236table_http_req_rate(<table>)
14237 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14238 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14239 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
14240 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
14241 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
14242 keyword.
14243
14244table_kbytes_in(<table>)
14245 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14246 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014247 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014248 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14249 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14250 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
14251 keyword.
14252
14253table_kbytes_out(<table>)
14254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014257 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
14258 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
14259 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
14260 keyword.
14261
14262table_server_id(<table>)
14263 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14264 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14265 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
14266 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
14267 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
14268 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
14269
14270table_sess_cnt(<table>)
14271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014274 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
14275 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14276 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
14277 keyword.
14278
14279table_sess_rate(<table>)
14280 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14281 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14282 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
14283 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
14284 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
14285 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
14286 keyword.
14287
14288table_trackers(<table>)
14289 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14290 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
14291 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
14292 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
14293 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
14294 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
14295 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
14296 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
14297 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
14298 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
14299
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014300upper
14301 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
14302 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14303 type. The result is of type string.
14304
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020014305url_dec
14306 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
14307 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
14308
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014309ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014310 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014311 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
14312 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
14313 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014314 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
14315 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
14316 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
14317 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014318 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014319 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
14320 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014321
14322 Example:
14323 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
14324 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
14325
14326 message Point {
14327 int32 latitude = 1;
14328 int32 longitude = 2;
14329 }
14330
14331 message PPoint {
14332 Point point = 59;
14333 }
14334
14335 message Rectangle {
14336 // One corner of the rectangle.
14337 PPoint lo = 48;
14338 // The other corner of the rectangle.
14339 PPoint hi = 49;
14340 }
14341
14342 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
14343 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
14344 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
14345
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014346 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14347 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014348 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014349 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
14350
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014351 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014352
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014353 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010014354
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014355 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010014356 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
14357 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
14358
14359 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
14360 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
14361 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
14362
14363 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
14364 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
14365 interpret the previous binary sample.
14366
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010014367
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014368unset-var(<var name>)
14369 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
14370 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
14371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
14372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
14374 response),
14375 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14376 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
14377 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
14378 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
14379
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014380utime(<format>[,<offset>])
14381 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14382 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
14383 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14384 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14385 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14386 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
14387
14388 Example :
14389
14390 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014391 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014392 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14393
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014394word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14395 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
14396 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
14397 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
14398 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
14399 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
14400
14401 Example :
14402 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
14403 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14404 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
14405 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
14406 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010014407
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014408wt6([<avalanche>])
14409 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
14410 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14411 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14412 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14413 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14414 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14415 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014416 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
14417 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014418
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014419xor(<value>)
14420 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014421 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014422 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014423 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014424 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014425 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14426 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014427 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014428 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14429 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014431 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014432
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010014433xxh32([<seed>])
14434 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
14435 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14436 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14437 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14438 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14439 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14440 as cryptographically secure.
14441
14442xxh64([<seed>])
14443 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14444 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14445 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14446 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14447 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14448 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14449 as cryptographically secure.
14450
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014451
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144527.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014453--------------------------------------------
14454
14455A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14456not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14457"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14458The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14459
14460always_false : boolean
14461 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14462 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14463
14464always_true : boolean
14465 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14466 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14467
14468avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014469 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14471 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14472 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14473 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14474 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14475 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14476 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14477 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14478 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14479 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14480 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14481 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14482 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014484be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014485 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14486 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14487 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14488 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014489 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14490
14491be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14493 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14494 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14495 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14496 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014497 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14498 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014499
14500 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14501 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14502 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014504be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14505 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14506 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14507 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014508 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14510 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014511
14512 Example :
14513 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14514 backend dynamic
14515 mode http
14516 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14517 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014518
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014519bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014520 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14521 of the string.
14522
14523bool(<bool>) : bool
14524 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14525 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014527connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14528 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014529 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014530 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14531 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014532
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014533 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014534 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014535 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14536
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014537 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14538 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014539
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014540 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014541 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014543 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014544 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014545 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014546 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014547
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014548 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14549 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014550 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014551 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014552
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014553cpu_calls : integer
14554 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14555 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14556 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14557 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14558 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14559 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14560
14561cpu_ns_avg : integer
14562 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14563 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14564 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14565 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14566 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14567 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14568 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14569 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14570 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14571 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14572 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14573
14574cpu_ns_tot : integer
14575 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14576 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14577 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14578 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14579 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14580 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14581 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14582 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14583 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14584 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14585 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14586 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14587 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14588
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014589date([<offset>]) : integer
14590 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14591 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14592 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14593 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014594 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14595
14596 Example :
14597
14598 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14599 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014600
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014601date_us : integer
14602 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14603 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14604 from the same timeval structure.
14605
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014606distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14607 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14608 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14609 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14610 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14611 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14612 list of supported tokens.
14613
14614distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14615 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14616 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14617 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14618 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14619 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14620 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14621 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14622 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14623 supported tokens.
14624
14625 Example :
14626 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14627 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14628 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14629 # send large files to the big farm
14630 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14631
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014632env(<name>) : string
14633 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14634 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14635 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14636 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14637 certain way.
14638
14639 Examples :
14640 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14641 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14642
14643 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14644 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014646fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14647 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014648 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14649 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14651 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014652 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014653 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14654 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014655
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014656fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14657 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14658 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14659 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14662 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14663 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14664 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14665 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14666 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14667 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14668 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14669 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014670
14671 Example :
14672 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14673 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14674 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14675 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14676 frontend mail
14677 bind :25
14678 mode tcp
14679 maxconn 100
14680 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14681 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14682 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14683 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014684
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014685hostname : string
14686 Returns the system hostname.
14687
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014688int(<integer>) : signed integer
14689 Returns a signed integer.
14690
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014691ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14692 Returns an ipv4.
14693
14694ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14695 Returns an ipv6.
14696
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014697lat_ns_avg : integer
14698 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14699 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14700 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14701 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14702 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14703 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14704 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14705 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14706 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14707 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14708 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14709 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14710 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14711 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14712
14713lat_ns_tot : integer
14714 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14715 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14716 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14717 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14718 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14719 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14720 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14721 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14722 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14723 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14724 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14725 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14726 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14727 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14728 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14729 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14730 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14731 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14732 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14733
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014734meth(<method>) : method
14735 Returns a method.
14736
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014737nbproc : integer
14738 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14739 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14740 and debugging purposes.
14741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014742nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14743 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14744 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14745 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014746 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14747 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14748 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014749
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014750prio_class : integer
14751 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14752 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14753 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14754
14755prio_offset : integer
14756 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14757 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14758 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14759 set-priority-offset".
14760
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014761proc : integer
14762 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14763 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14764 debugging purposes.
14765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014767 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14768 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14769 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014770 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14771 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14772 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14773 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14774 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14775
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014776rand([<range>]) : integer
14777 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14778 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14779 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14780 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14781 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14782
Luca Schimweg77306662019-09-10 15:42:52 +020014783uuid([<version>]) : string
14784 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
14785 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
14786 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
14787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14789 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14790 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14791 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14792 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14793 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014794 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14795 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14796
14797srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14798 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14799 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14800 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14801 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14802 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14803 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14804 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14805
14806 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14807 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808
14809srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14810 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14811 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14812 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014813 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014814 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14815 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14816 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14817
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014818srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14819 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14820 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14821 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14822 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14823 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14824 fetch methods.
14825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14827 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14828 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014829 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14831 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014832 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833 overloading servers).
14834
14835 Example :
14836 # Redirect to a separate back
14837 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14838 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14839 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14840
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014841stopping : boolean
14842 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14843 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14844 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14845
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014846str(<string>) : string
14847 Returns a string.
14848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14850 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14851 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14852
14853table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14854 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14855 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14856 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14857
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014858thread : integer
14859 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14860 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14861 and debugging purposes.
14862
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014863var(<var-name>) : undefined
14864 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014865 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14866 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14869 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014870 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014871 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14872 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014873 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014874 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200148767.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014877----------------------------------
14878
14879The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14880closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14881methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14882sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14883TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014884the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14885counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014886"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14887used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14888can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14889Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14890table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14891tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14892currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014893
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014894bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014895 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14896 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14897 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014899be_id : integer
14900 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14901 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14902
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014903be_name : string
14904 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14905 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907dst : ip
14908 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14909 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14910 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14911 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014912 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14913 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14914 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14915 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14916 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14917 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014918
14919dst_conn : integer
14920 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14921 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14922 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14923 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14924 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14925 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14926 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14927 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014928
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014929dst_is_local : boolean
14930 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14931 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14932 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14933 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014934 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014935 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14936 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14937 it only once per connection.
14938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939dst_port : integer
14940 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14941 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14942 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14943 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14944 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14945 an HTTP header.
14946
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014947fc_http_major : integer
14948 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14949 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14950 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14951
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014952fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14953 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14954 header.
14955
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014956fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14957 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14958 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14959 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14960 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14961 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14962 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14963
14964fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14965 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14966 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14967 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14968 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14969 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14970 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14971
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014972fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14973 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14974 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14975 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14976 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14977
14978fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14979 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14980 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14981 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14982 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14983
14984fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14985 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14986 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14987 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14988 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14989
14990fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14991 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14992 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14993 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14994 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14995
14996fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14997 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14998 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14999 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15000 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15001
15002fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
15003 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
15004 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
15005 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
15006 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
15007
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020015008fe_defbe : string
15009 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
15010 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
15011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015012fe_id : integer
15013 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010015014 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15016
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010015017fe_name : string
15018 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
15019 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
15020 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
15021
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015022sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015023sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15024sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15025sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015026 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
15027 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15028 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
15029
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015030sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015031sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15032sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15033sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015034 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
15035 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
15036 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
15037
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015038sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015039sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15040sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15041sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015042 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15043 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015044 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15045 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15046 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015047
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015048 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015049 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15050 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015051 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15052 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
15053 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015054 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15055 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15056
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015057sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15058sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15059sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15060sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15061 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
15062 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
15063 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
15064 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
15065 when a first ACL was verified.
15066
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015067sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015068sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15069sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15070sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015071 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015072 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
15073
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015074sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015075sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15076sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
15077sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015078 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15079 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
15080 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
15081
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015082sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015083sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15084sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15085sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015086 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
15087 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
15088 See also src_conn_rate.
15089
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015090sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015091sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15092sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15093sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015094 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015095 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015096
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015097sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15098sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15099sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15100sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15101 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15102 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15103
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015104sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15105sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15106sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15107sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15108 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15109 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
15110
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015111sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015112sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15113sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
15114sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015115 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
15116 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15117 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015118 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15119 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15120 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015121
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015122sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15123sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15124sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15125sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15126 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15127 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
15128 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15129 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15130 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15131 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015133sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015134sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15135sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15136sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015137 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015138 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
15139 See also src_http_err_cnt.
15140
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015141sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015142sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15143sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15144sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015145 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
15146 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15147 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
15148 src_http_err_rate.
15149
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015150sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015151sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15152sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15153sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015154 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015155 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15156 src_http_req_cnt.
15157
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015158sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015159sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15160sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15161sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015162 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
15163 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
15164 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
15165 src_http_req_rate.
15166
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015167sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015168sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15169sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15170sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015171 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015172 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15173 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15174 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15175 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015176
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015177 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015178 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
15179 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015180 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15181
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015182sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
15183sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15184sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15185sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15186 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
15187 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
15188 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
15189 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
15190 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
15191
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015192sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015193sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15194sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
15195sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015196 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
15197 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15198 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015199
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015200sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015201sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15202sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
15203sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015204 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
15205 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
15206 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015207
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015208sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015209sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15210sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15211sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015212 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015213 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
15214 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
15215 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015216 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015217 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
15218
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015219sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015220sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15221sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15222sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015223 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
15224 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15225 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
15226 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
15227 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015228 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015229
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015230sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015231sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15232sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
15233sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020015234 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
15235 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
15236 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
15237
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020015238sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020015239sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15240sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
15241sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015242 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
15243 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015244 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015245 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
15246 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015247 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
15248 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
15249 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010015250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015251so_id : integer
15252 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
15253 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
15254 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015256src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015257 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015258 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
15259 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
15260 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015261 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
15262 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
15263 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010015264 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
15265 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
15266 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
15267 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
15268 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
15269 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
15270 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015271
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015272 Example:
15273 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
15274 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
15275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
15277 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
15278 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
15279 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015280 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015282src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
15283 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
15284 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015285 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015286 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15289 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15290 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15291 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15292 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15293 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15294 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015295
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015296 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015297 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
15298 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
15299 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
15300 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015301 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020015302 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
15303 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
15304
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015305src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15306 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15307 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15308 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
15309 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
15310 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
15311 was verified.
15312
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015313src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015314 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015315 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015316 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015317 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015320 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015321 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15322 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015323 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015325src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
15326 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
15327 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15328 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015329 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015331src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015332 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015333 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015334 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015335 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015336
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015337src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15338 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
15339 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15340 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15341 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
15342
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015343src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
15344 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
15345 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
15346 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
15347 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
15348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015350 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015351 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015352 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15353 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015354 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
15355 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15356 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020015357
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015358src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
15359 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
15360 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
15361 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
15362 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
15363 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
15364 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
15365 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
15366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015367src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015368 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015369 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015370 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015371 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015374src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
15375 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
15376 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15377 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
15378 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015379 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015382 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015383 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15384 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015385 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015387src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
15388 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
15389 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
15390 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015391 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015392 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
15395 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15396 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15397 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015398 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15400 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015401
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015402 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015403 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010015404 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020015405 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015406
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015407src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
15408 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
15409 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15410 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
15411 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
15412 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
15413 connection when a first ACL was verified.
15414
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015415src_is_local : boolean
15416 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
15417 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
15418 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
15419 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015420 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020015421 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
15422 once per connection.
15423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015425 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
15426 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
15427 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
15428 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
15429 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015430
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020015432 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
15433 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15434 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
15435 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
15436 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015437
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015438src_port : integer
15439 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
15440 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
15441 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
15442 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015444src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015445 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015446 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15447 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15448 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015449 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015451src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15452 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15453 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15454 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15455 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015456 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15459 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15460 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15461 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15462 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15463 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15464 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15465 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15466 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015467
15468 Example :
15469 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15470 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15471 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15472 listen ssh
15473 bind :22
15474 mode tcp
15475 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015476 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015478 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015480srv_id : integer
15481 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15482 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15483 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015484
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154857.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015486----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15489closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15490when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15491usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015492future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015493
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001549451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15495 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15496 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15497 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15498 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15499 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15500
15501 Example :
15502 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15503 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15504 # the request.
15505 frontend http-in
15506 bind *:8081
15507 default_backend servers
15508 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15509 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15510
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015511ssl_bc : boolean
15512 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15513 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15514 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15515
15516ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15517 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15518 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15519
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015520ssl_bc_alpn : string
15521 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15522 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015523 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015524 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15525 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15526 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15527 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15528 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15529 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15530
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015531ssl_bc_cipher : string
15532 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15533 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15534
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015535ssl_bc_client_random : binary
15536 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15537 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15538 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15539
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015540ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15541 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15542 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15543 session or a TLS ticket.
15544
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015545ssl_bc_npn : string
15546 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15547 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020015548 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015549 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15550 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15551 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15552 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15553 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15554
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015555ssl_bc_protocol : string
15556 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15557 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15558
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015559ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015560 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015561 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15562 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015563
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015564ssl_bc_server_random : binary
15565 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
15566 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15567 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15568
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015569ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15570 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15571 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15572 if session was reused or not.
15573
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015574ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15575 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15576 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15577 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15578 BoringSSL.
15579
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015580ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15581 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15582 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15585 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15586 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15587 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15588 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15589 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015591ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15592 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15593 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15594 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15595 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015596
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015597ssl_c_der : binary
15598 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15599 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15600 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015602ssl_c_err : integer
15603 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15604 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15605 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15606 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15607 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015609ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15610 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15611 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15612 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15613 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15614 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15615 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15616 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15617 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015619ssl_c_key_alg : string
15620 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15621 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15622 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015624ssl_c_notafter : string
15625 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15626 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15627 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629ssl_c_notbefore : string
15630 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15631 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15632 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015634ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15635 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15636 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15637 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15638 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15639 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15640 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15641 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15642 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644ssl_c_serial : binary
15645 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15646 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15647 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015649ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15650 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15651 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15652 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015653 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15654 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15655
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015656 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015657 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015659ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15660 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15661 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15662 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664ssl_c_used : boolean
15665 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15666 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015668ssl_c_verify : integer
15669 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15670 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15671 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15672 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015674ssl_c_version : integer
15675 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15676 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015677
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015678ssl_f_der : binary
15679 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15680 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15681 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15684 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15685 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15686 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15687 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015688 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015689 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15690 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15691 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693ssl_f_key_alg : string
15694 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15695 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15696 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015697
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015698ssl_f_notafter : string
15699 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15700 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15701 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703ssl_f_notbefore : string
15704 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15705 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15706 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015708ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15709 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15710 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15711 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15712 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15713 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15714 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15715 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15716 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015717
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015718ssl_f_serial : binary
15719 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15720 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15721 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015722
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015723ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15724 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15725 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15726 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015728ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15729 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15730 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15731 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015733ssl_f_version : integer
15734 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15735 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15736
15737ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015738 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15739 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15740 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015742 Example :
15743 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15744 listen http-https
15745 bind :80
15746 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15747 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15748
15749ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15750 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15751 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15752
15753ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015754 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15756 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15757 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15758 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15759 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15760 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15761 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15762 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764ssl_fc_cipher : string
15765 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15766 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015767
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015768ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15769 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15770 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015771 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015772
15773ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15774 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15775 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015776 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015777
15778ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15779 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15780 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15781 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015782 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015783 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015784
15785ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15786 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15787 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015788 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015789
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015790ssl_fc_client_random : binary
15791 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15792 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15793 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015795ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015796 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15797 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015798 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15799 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15800 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15801 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015802
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015803ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15804 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15805 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15806 wait until the handshake happened.
15807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15809 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015810 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15811 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015812 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015813 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015814
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015815ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015816 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015817 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15818 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015820ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015821 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015822 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15823 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15824 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15825 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15826 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15827 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15828 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015830ssl_fc_protocol : string
15831 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15832 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015833
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015834ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015835 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015836 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15837 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015838
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040015839ssl_fc_server_random : binary
15840 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
15841 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
15842 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
15843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15845 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15846 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15847 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15848 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015849
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015850ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15851 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15852 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15853 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15854 BoringSSL.
15855
15856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857ssl_fc_sni : string
15858 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15859 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15860 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15861 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15862 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15863
15864 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15865 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15866 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015867 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015868 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015870 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15872 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15875 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15876 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015877
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015878
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200158797.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015882Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15883sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15884only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15885For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15886be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15887can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15888sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15889for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15890content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015892payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015893 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015894 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15895 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15898 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015899 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015900 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015901
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015902req.hdrs : string
15903 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15904 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15905 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15906 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15907
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015908req.hdrs_bin : binary
15909 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15910 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15911 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15912 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15913 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15914 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15915
15916 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15917
15918 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15919 str: <int:length><bytes>
15920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015921req.len : integer
15922req_len : integer (deprecated)
15923 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15924 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15925 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15926 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15927 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15928 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15929 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15930 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15933 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015934 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15935 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15936 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15937 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015939 ACL alternatives :
15940 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015941
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15943 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15944 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15945 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15946 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 ACL alternatives :
15949 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015951 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015953req.proto_http : boolean
15954req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15955 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15956 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15957 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15958 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15959 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15960 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15961 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963 Example:
15964 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15965 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15966 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015967 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015969req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15970rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15971 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15972 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15973 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15974 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15975 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15976 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15977 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015979 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15980 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15981 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15982 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15983 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15984 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015986 ACL derivatives :
15987 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015989 Example :
15990 listen tse-farm
15991 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15992 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15993 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15994 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15995 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15996 persist rdp-cookie
15997 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15998 # This is only useful makes sense if
15999 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
16000 stick-table type string size 204800
16001 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
16002 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
16003 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016005 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
16006 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016008req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
16009rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
16010 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
16011 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
16012 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
16013 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015 ACL derivatives :
16016 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016017
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016018req.ssl_alpn : string
16019 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
16020 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
16021 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
16022 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
16023 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
16024 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016025 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016026
16027 Examples :
16028 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16029 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16030 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020016031 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110016032 default_backend bk_default
16033
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016034req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
16035 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
16036 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016037 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
16038 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
16039 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
16040 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
16041 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043req.ssl_hello_type : integer
16044req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16045 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16046 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
16047 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16048 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16049 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
16050 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16051 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016053req.ssl_sni : string
16054req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
16055 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
16056 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
16057 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
16058 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16059 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16060 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
16061 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
16062 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
16063 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
16064 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
16065 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
16066 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016068 ACL derivatives :
16069 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016071 Examples :
16072 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
16073 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
16074 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
16075 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
16076 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020016077
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053016078req.ssl_st_ext : integer
16079 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
16080 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
16081 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
16082 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
16083 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
16084 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
16085 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
16086 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
16087 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
16088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016089req.ssl_ver : integer
16090req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
16091 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
16092 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
16093 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
16094 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
16095 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
16096 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
16097 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016098 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016099 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016101 ACL derivatives :
16102 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016103
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020016104res.len : integer
16105 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
16106 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
16107 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
16108 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
16109 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
16110 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
16111 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
16112 content inspection.
16113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016114res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
16115 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020016116 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
16117 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
16118 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
16119 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
16122 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
16123 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
16124 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
16125 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016127 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016128
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020016129res.ssl_hello_type : integer
16130rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
16131 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
16132 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
16133 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
16134 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
16135 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
16136 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
16137 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
16138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139wait_end : boolean
16140 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
16141 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016143 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
16144 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016145 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016146 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
16147 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016149 Examples :
16150 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
16151 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
16152 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016154 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
16155 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16156 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
16157 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
16158 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
16159 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
16160 tcp-request content reject
16161
16162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200161637.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016164--------------------------------------
16165
16166It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
16167This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
16168data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
16169its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
16170HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
16171content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
16172to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
16173more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
16174response are indexed.
16175
16176base : string
16177 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
16178 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
16179 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
16180 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
16181 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
16182 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
16183 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
16184 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
16185
16186 ACL derivatives :
16187 base : exact string match
16188 base_beg : prefix match
16189 base_dir : subdir match
16190 base_dom : domain match
16191 base_end : suffix match
16192 base_len : length match
16193 base_reg : regex match
16194 base_sub : substring match
16195
16196base32 : integer
16197 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
16198 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
16199 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016200 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
16201 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
16202 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016203
16204base32+src : binary
16205 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
16206 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
16207 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
16208 per-URL counters.
16209
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016210capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
16211 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
16212 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16213 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
16214
16215capture.req.method : string
16216 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
16217 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
16218 because it's allocated.
16219
16220capture.req.uri : string
16221 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
16222 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
16223 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
16224 allocated.
16225
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016226capture.req.ver : string
16227 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16228 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
16229 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
16230
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010016231capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
16232 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
16233 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
16234 The first entry is an index of 0.
16235 See also: "capture response header"
16236
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020016237capture.res.ver : string
16238 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
16239 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
16240 persistent flag.
16241
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016242req.body : binary
16243 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
16244 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16245 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
16246 the first chunk is analyzed.
16247
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020016248req.body_param([<name>) : string
16249 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
16250 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
16251 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
16252 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
16253 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
16254 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
16255 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
16256 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
16257 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
16258 given.
16259
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020016260req.body_len : integer
16261 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
16262 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
16263 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
16264 "option http-buffer-request".
16265
16266req.body_size : integer
16267 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
16268 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
16269 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
16270 that the request body has been buffered made available using
16271 "option http-buffer-request".
16272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016273req.cook([<name>]) : string
16274cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16275 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16276 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16277 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
16278 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
16279 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
16280 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
16281 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
16282 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
16283
16284 ACL derivatives :
16285 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
16286 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
16287 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
16288 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
16289 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
16290 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
16291 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
16292 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016294req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16295cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16296 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16297 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016299req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16300cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16301 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16302 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
16303 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
16304 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016306cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16307 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
16308 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
16309 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
16310 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016311 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016312 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
16313 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
16314 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
16315 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016317hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16318 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
16319 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
16320 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
16321 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016322 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016324req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
16325 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16326 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16327 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16328 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16329 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16330 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
16331 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
16332 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016334req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16335 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16336 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16337 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16338 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016340req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16341 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
16342 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
16343 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16344 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16345 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16346 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
16347 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
16348 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000016349 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016350 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016351 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016353 ACL derivatives :
16354 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16355 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16356 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16357 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16358 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16359 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16360 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16361 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16362
16363req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16364hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
16365 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
16366 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
16367 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
16368 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
16369 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
16370 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
16371 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
16372 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
16373 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
16374
16375req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16376hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16377 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
16378 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
16379 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
16380 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16381 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016382 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016383 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
16384 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
16385
16386req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16387hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16388 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
16389 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
16390 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
16391 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
16392 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
16393 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
16394 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
16395
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010016396
16397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016398http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
16399 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
16400 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
16401 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16402 basic auth is supported.
16403
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016404http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
16405 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
16406 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
16407 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
16408 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016409 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
16410 basic auth is supported.
16411
16412 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010016413 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
16414 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
16415 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
16416 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417
16418http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016419 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
16420 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
16422 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020016423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016424method : integer + string
16425 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
16426 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
16427 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
16428 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
16429 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
16430 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
16431 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016432
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016433 ACL derivatives :
16434 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016436 Example :
16437 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
16438 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
16439 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016440
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016441path : string
16442 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
16443 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
16444 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
16445 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
16446 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016447 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450 ACL derivatives :
16451 path : exact string match
16452 path_beg : prefix match
16453 path_dir : subdir match
16454 path_dom : domain match
16455 path_end : suffix match
16456 path_len : length match
16457 path_reg : regex match
16458 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016459
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016460query : string
16461 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
16462 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
16463 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
16464 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016465 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016466 which stops before the question mark.
16467
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016468req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16469 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16470 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16471 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16472 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474req.ver : string
16475req_ver : string (deprecated)
16476 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16477 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16478 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480 ACL derivatives :
16481 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016483res.comp : boolean
16484 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16485 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16486 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488res.comp_algo : string
16489 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16490 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16491 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016493res.cook([<name>]) : string
16494scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16495 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16496 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16497 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016499 ACL derivatives :
16500 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016502res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16503scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16504 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16505 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16506 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016508res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16509scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16510 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16511 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16512 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016514res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16515 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16516 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16517 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16518 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16519 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16520 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16521 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16522 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16523 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016524
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016525res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16526 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16527 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16528 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16529 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16530 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016532res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16533shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16534 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16535 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16536 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16537 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16538 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16539 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16540 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16541 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016543 ACL derivatives :
16544 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16545 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16546 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16547 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16548 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16549 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16550 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16551 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16552
16553res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16554shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16555 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16556 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16557 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16558 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16559 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016561res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16562shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16563 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16564 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16565 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16566 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16567 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16568 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016569
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016570res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16571 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16572 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16573 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16574 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016576res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16577shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16578 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16579 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16580 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16581 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16582 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16583 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016585res.ver : string
16586resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16587 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16588 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016590 ACL derivatives :
16591 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016593set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16594 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16595 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016596 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016597 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016599 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16600 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016602status : integer
16603 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16604 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16605 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016606
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016607unique-id : string
16608 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16609 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16610 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16611 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16612 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16613 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016615url : string
16616 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16617 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16618 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16619 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16620 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16621 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16622 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016624 ACL derivatives :
16625 url : exact string match
16626 url_beg : prefix match
16627 url_dir : subdir match
16628 url_dom : domain match
16629 url_end : suffix match
16630 url_len : length match
16631 url_reg : regex match
16632 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016633
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016634url_ip : ip
16635 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16636 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16637 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16638 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16639 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16640 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16641 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016643url_port : integer
16644 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16645 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16646 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16647 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016648
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016649urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16650url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016651 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16652 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016653 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16654 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16655 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16656 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016657 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16658 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016659 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16660 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016662 ACL derivatives :
16663 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16664 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16665 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16666 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16667 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16668 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16669 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16670 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016671
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016673 Example :
16674 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16675 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16676 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16677 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016678
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016679urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16681 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16682 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016683
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016684url32 : integer
16685 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16686 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16687 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16688 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16689 is an unsigned integer.
16690
16691url32+src : binary
16692 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16693 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16694 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16695
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166977.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016698---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016699
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016700Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16701every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016702order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016703
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016704ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16705---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016706FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016707HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016708HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16709HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016710HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16711HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16712HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16713HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16714LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016715METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016716METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016717METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16718METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16719METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16720METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016721METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016722METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016723RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016724REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016725TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016726WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16727---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016728
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167308. Logging
16731----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016732
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016733One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16734provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16735very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16736provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16737state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016738to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016739headers.
16740
16741In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16742about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16743send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16744
16745 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16746 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16747 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16748 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16749 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016750 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016751 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016752
16753The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16754allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16755as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16756while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16757real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16758delay.
16759
16760
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167618.1. Log levels
16762---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016763
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016764TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016765source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016766HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16767in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16768track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16769syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16770about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016771
16772
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200167738.2. Log formats
16774----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016776HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016777and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16778slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16779options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780
16781 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16782 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16783 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16784 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16785 extents.
16786
16787 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16788 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16789 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16790 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16791 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16792
16793 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16794 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16795 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16796 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16797 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16798
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016799 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16800 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16801 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16802 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16803
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016804 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16805
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016806Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16807specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16808field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16809servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16810always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16811identifier.
16812
16813Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16814 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16815 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16816 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16817 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16818
16819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168208.2.1. Default log format
16821-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016822
16823This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16824as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16825format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16826
16827 Example :
16828 listen www
16829 mode http
16830 log global
16831 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16832
16833 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16834 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16835 (www/HTTP)
16836
16837 Field Format Extract from the example above
16838 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16839 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16840 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16841 4 'to' to
16842 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16843 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16844
16845Detailed fields description :
16846 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16847 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16848 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16849 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16850 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16851 and processed the connection.
16852 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16853
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016854In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16855"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16856connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16857
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016858It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16859will eventually disappear.
16860
16861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168628.2.2. TCP log format
16863---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016864
16865The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16866is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16867information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16868counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16869emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16870environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16871the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16872sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016873specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16874not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16875fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16876marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016877
16878 Example :
16879 frontend fnt
16880 mode tcp
16881 option tcplog
16882 log global
16883 default_backend bck
16884
16885 backend bck
16886 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16887
16888 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16889 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16890 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16891
16892 Field Format Extract from the example above
16893 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16894 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16895 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16896 4 frontend_name fnt
16897 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16898 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16899 7 bytes_read* 212
16900 8 termination_state --
16901 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16902 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16903
16904Detailed fields description :
16905 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016906 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16907 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16908 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016909 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016910 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016911 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016912
16913 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016914 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16915 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16916 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016917
16918 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16919 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16920 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016921 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16922 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16923 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16924 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016925
16926 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16927 and processed the connection.
16928
16929 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16930 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16931 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16932 applications.
16933
16934 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16935 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16936 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16937 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16938 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16939
16940 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16941 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16942 See "Timers" below for more details.
16943
16944 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16945 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16946 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16947 "Timers" below for more details.
16948
16949 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016950 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016951 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16952 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16953 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16954 details.
16955
16956 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16957 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16958 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16959 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16960 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16961
16962 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16963 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16964 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16965 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16966 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16967 for more details.
16968
16969 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016970 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016971 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16972 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16973 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016974 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016975
16976 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16977 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16978 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16979 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16980 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16981 caused by a denial of service attack.
16982
16983 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16984 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16985 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16986 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16987 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16988 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16989 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16990 denial of service attack.
16991
16992 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16993 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16994 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16995 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16996 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16997 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16998 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16999 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
17000 be processed than on other servers.
17001
17002 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17003 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17004 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17005 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17006 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17007 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17008 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17009 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17010 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17011 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17012 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17013 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17014 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17015
17016 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17017 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17018 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17019 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17020 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17021 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017022 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017023 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17024
17025 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17026 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17027 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17028 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17029 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17030 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017031 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017032 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17033 occurs.
17034
17035
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170368.2.3. HTTP log format
17037----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017038
17039The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
17040is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
17041the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
17042are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
17043emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
17044generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
17045"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
17046which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017047frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
17048is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017049
17050Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
17051slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
17052with a star ('*') after the field name below.
17053
17054 Example :
17055 frontend http-in
17056 mode http
17057 option httplog
17058 log global
17059 default_backend bck
17060
17061 backend static
17062 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
17063
17064 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
17065 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
17066 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017067 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017068
17069 Field Format Extract from the example above
17070 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
17071 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017072 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017073 4 frontend_name http-in
17074 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017075 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017076 7 status_code 200
17077 8 bytes_read* 2750
17078 9 captured_request_cookie -
17079 10 captured_response_cookie -
17080 11 termination_state ----
17081 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
17082 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
17083 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
17084 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
17085 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017086
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017087Detailed fields description :
17088 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017089 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
17090 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
17091 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017092 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017093 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017094 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017095
17096 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010017097 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
17098 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
17099 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017100
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017101 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
17102 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017103
17104 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
17105 and processed the connection.
17106
17107 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
17108 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
17109 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
17110
17111 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
17112 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
17113 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
17114 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
17115 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
17116 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
17117
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017118 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
17119 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
17120 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017121 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017122 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
17123 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017124 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
17125 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017126
17127 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
17128 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017129 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017130
17131 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
17132 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017133 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
17134 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017135
17136 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
17137 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
17138 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
17139 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
17140 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017141 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
17142 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017143
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017144 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
17145 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
17146 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
17147 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
17148 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
17149 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
17150 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017151 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017152
17153 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
17154 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
17155 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
17156
17157 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
17158 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017159 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017160 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
17161 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
17162 overflowing.
17163
17164 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
17165 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
17166 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
17167 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
17168 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
17169 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
17170 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
17171 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17172
17173 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
17174 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
17175 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
17176 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
17177 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
17178 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
17179 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
17180 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
17181
17182 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
17183 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
17184 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
17185 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
17186 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
17187 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
17188 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
17189
17190 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017191 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017192 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
17193 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
17194 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017195 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017196 system.
17197
17198 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
17199 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
17200 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
17201 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
17202 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
17203 caused by a denial of service attack.
17204
17205 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
17206 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
17207 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
17208 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
17209 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
17210 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
17211 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
17212 denial of service attack.
17213
17214 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
17215 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
17216 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
17217 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
17218 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
17219 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
17220 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
17221 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
17222 processed than on other servers.
17223
17224 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
17225 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
17226 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
17227 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
17228 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
17229 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
17230 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
17231 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
17232 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
17233 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
17234 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
17235 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
17236 should not be attributed to the logged server.
17237
17238 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17239 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
17240 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
17241 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
17242 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
17243 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017244 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017245 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
17246
17247 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
17248 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
17249 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
17250 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
17251 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
17252 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017253 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017254 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
17255 occurs.
17256
17257 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
17258 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
17259 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
17260 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
17261 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
17262 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
17263 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
17264 cookies" below for more details.
17265
17266 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
17267 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
17268 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
17269 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
17270 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
17271 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
17272 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
17273 and cookies" below for more details.
17274
17275 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
17276 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
17277 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
17278 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
17279 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
17280 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
17281 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
17282 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
17283
17284
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200172858.2.4. Custom log format
17286------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017287
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017288The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017289mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017290
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017291HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017292Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
17293separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
17294prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
17295
17296Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
17297variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017298("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017299
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017300If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020017301as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010017302less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
17303the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
17304
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017305Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017306In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010017307in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017308
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017309Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
17310'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
17311https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
17312such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
17313
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017314Flags are :
17315 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017316 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017317 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
17318 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017319
17320 Example:
17321
17322 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
17323 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
17324
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010017325 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
17326
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017327At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
17328
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017329 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
17330 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017331
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017332the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017333
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017334 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
17335 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
17336 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017337
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017338and the default TCP format is defined this way :
17339
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017340 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
17341 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017342
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017343Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
17344
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017345 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017346 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017347 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
17348 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
17349 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017350 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
17351 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
17352 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017353 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017354 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
17355 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000017356 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000017357 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
17358 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010017359 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020017360 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017361 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017362 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017363 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020017364 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080017365 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017366 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
17367 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
17368 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
17369 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
17370 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017371 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017372 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
17373 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017374 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017375 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
17376 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017377 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17378 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
17379 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017380 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017381 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
17382 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017383 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017384 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
17385 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
17386 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020017387 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020017388 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017389 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
17390 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
17391 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
17392 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020017393 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020017394 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017395 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017396 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010017397 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017398 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017399 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
17400 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
17401 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017402 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017403 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
17404 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010017405 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017406 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
17407 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020017408 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017409 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017410 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010017411 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017412
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020017413 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010017414
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017415
174168.2.5. Error log format
17417-----------------------
17418
17419When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
17420protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
17421By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
17422"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017423will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010017424logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
17425
17426The format looks like this :
17427
17428 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
17429 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
17430 Connection error during SSL handshake
17431
17432 Field Format Extract from the example above
17433 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
17434 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
17435 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
17436 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
17437 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
17438
17439These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
17440failures.
17441
17442
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174438.3. Advanced logging options
17444-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017445
17446Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
17447just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
17448options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
17449for more information about their usage.
17450
17451
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174528.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
17453------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017454
17455It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
17456haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
17457commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
17458monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
17459ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
17460
17461 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
17462 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
17463 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
17464 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17465
17466 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17467 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17468 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017469 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017470 such as other load-balancers.
17471
17472 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17473 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17474 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17475
17476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174778.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17478----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017479
17480The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17481what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17482or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017483"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017484just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17485log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17486after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17487is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17488with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17489with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17490
17491
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174928.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17493------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017494
17495Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17496for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17497"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17498retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17499raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17500a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17501file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17502you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17503"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17504
17505
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17507--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017508
17509Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17510multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17511them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17512"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17513logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17514error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17515and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17516too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17517useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17518alternative.
17519
17520
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175218.4. Timing events
17522------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017523
17524Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17525reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17526the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17527frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017528mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17529addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17530
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017531Timings events in HTTP mode:
17532
17533 first request 2nd request
17534 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17535 t tr t tr ...
17536 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17537 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17538 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17539 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17540 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17541
17542Timings events in TCP mode:
17543
17544 TCP session
17545 |<----------------->|
17546 t t
17547 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17548 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17549 |<------ Tt ------->|
17550
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017551 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017552 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017553 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17554 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17555 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017556 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017557 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17558 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17559 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17560 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017561
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017562 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17563 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17564 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017565 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17566 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17567 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17568 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17569 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17570 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017571
17572 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17573 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17574 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17575 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17576 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17577 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17578 request typed by hand during a test.
17579
17580 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17581 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017582 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017583 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17584 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17585 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17586 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017587
17588 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17589 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17590 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17591 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17592 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17593
17594 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17595 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17596 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17597 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17598 connection never established.
17599
17600 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17601 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17602 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17603 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17604 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17605 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17606 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17607 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17608 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17609 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17610 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17611
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017612 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17613 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17614 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17615 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17616 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17617 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17618
17619 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17620
17621 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17622 "Ta" can never be negative.
17623
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17625 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017626 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17627 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017628 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017630 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017631
17632 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017633 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17634 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017635
17636These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17637protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17638that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017639due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17640"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17641that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017642
17643Most common cases :
17644
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017645 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17646 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17647 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17648 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17649 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17650 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17651 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17652 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17653 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17654 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17655 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017656 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017657
17658 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17659 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17660 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17661 of ms on remote networks.
17662
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017663 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17664 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17665 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017666
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017667 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17668 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17669 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17670 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17671 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17672 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17673 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17674 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17675 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017676
17677Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17678
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017679 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017680 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017681 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017682
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017683 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017684 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17685 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17686
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017687 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017688 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17689 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17690 flags.
17691
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017692 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17693 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017694 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17695 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17696 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17697 the client connection was maintained open.
17698
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017699 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017700 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017701 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017702 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17703
17704
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177058.5. Session state at disconnection
17706-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017707
17708TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17709"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
177102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17711each of which has a special meaning :
17712
17713 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17714 session to terminate :
17715
17716 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17717
17718 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17719 server explicitly refused it.
17720
17721 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17722 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17723 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17724 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017725 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017726
17727 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17728 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017729
17730 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17731 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17732 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17733 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17734 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17735
17736 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17737 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17738 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17739 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17740 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17741
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017742 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17743 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17744
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017745 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17746 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17747 backup connections when going up.
17748
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017749 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17750
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017751 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17752 send or receive data.
17753
17754 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17755 send or receive data.
17756
17757 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17758 with nothing left in the buffers.
17759
17760 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17761
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017762 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017763 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17764
17765 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17766 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17767 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17768 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17769 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17770
17771 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17772 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17773
17774 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17775 server (HTTP only).
17776
17777 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17778
17779 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17780 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17781 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17782
17783 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17784 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17785 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17786
17787 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17788
17789 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17790 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17791
17792 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17793 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17794 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17795
17796 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17797 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017798 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17799 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017800
17801 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17802 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17803 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17804 another server.
17805
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017806 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017807 server.
17808
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017809 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17810 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17811 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17812 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17813
17814 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17815 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17816 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17817 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17818
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017819 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17820 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17821 "use-server" rule).
17822
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017823 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17824
17825 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17826 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17827
17828 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17829
17830 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17831 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17832 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17833
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017834 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17835 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017836 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017837 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17838 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17839
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017840 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17841
17842 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17843 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17844
17845 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17846
17847 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17848
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017849The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17850was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017851helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17852starvation, attacks, etc...
17853
17854The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17855alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17856easier finding and understanding.
17857
17858 Flags Reason
17859
17860 -- Normal termination.
17861
17862 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17863 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17864 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17865 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17866
17867 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17868 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17869 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17870 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17871 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17872 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017874 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17875 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017876 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017877
17878 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17879 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17880 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17881
17882 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17883 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17884 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17885 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17886 the server takes too long to respond.
17887
17888 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17889 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17890 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17891 long a time to respond.
17892
17893 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17894 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17895 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17896 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017897 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17898 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017899
17900 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17901 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17902 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17903 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17904 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017905 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017906 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17907 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17908 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17909 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17910 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17911 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17912 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17913 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017914 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017915 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17916 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17917 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017918
17919 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17920 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017921 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17922 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17923 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17924 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017925
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017926 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17927 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17928
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017929 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017930 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17931 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017932 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017933 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17934 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17935
17936 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17937 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17938 503 or 504 here.
17939
17940 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17941 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17942 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17943 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17944 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17945
17946 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17947 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017948 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017949 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17950 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17951
17952 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17953 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17954 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17955 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17956 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17957 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17958 between haproxy and the server.
17959
17960 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17961 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17962 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17963 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17964 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17965 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17966 solution is to fix the application.
17967
17968 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17969 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17970 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17971 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17972 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17973 external attacks.
17974
17975 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17976 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017977 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017978 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17979 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17980
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017981 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17982 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17983 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017984 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017985 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017986
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017987 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17988 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17989 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17990 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017991 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17992 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17993 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17994 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17995 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017996
17997 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17998 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17999 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
18000 returned an HTTP 403 error.
18001
18002 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
18003 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
18004 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
18005 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
18006
18007 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
18008 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
18009 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
18010 only be solved by proper system tuning.
18011
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018012The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
18013persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
18014important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
18015re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
18016
18017 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
18018
18019 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18020 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
18021 set on a GET request.
18022
18023 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
18024 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018025 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020018026 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
18027
18028 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
18029 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
18030 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
18031
18032 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
18033 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
18034 already got a cookie.
18035
18036 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18037 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
18038 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
18039 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
18040 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
18041
18042 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
18043 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18044 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18045
18046 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
18047 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
18048 new cookie was inserted in the response.
18049
18050 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
18051 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
18052
18053 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
18054 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
18055 then advertised in the response.
18056
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180588.6. Non-printable characters
18059-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018060
18061In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
18062consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
18063converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
18064prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
18065being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
18066escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
18067is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
18068'}' when logging headers.
18069
18070Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
18071issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
18072containing spaces is "User-Agent".
18073
18074Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
18075the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
18076performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
18077
18078
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180798.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
18080---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018081
18082Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
18083achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018084section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018085cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
18086the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
18087the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018088locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018089not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
18090user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
18091a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
18092wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
18093
18094 Examples :
18095 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
18096 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
18097
18098 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
18099 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
18100
18101
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
18103---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018104
18105Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
18106proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
18107the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
18108server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
18109
18110Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
18111response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018112section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018113
18114It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018115time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
18116appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018117are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
18118and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
18119follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
18120request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
18121in the logs.
18122
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018123As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
18124frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
18125an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
18126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018127 Example :
18128 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
18129 listen proxy-out
18130 mode http
18131 option httplog
18132 option logasap
18133 log global
18134 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
18135
18136 # log the name of the virtual server
18137 capture request header Host len 20
18138
18139 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
18140 capture request header Content-Length len 10
18141
18142 # log the beginning of the referrer
18143 capture request header Referer len 20
18144
18145 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
18146 capture response header Server len 20
18147
18148 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
18149 capture response header Content-Length len 10
18150
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018151 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018152 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
18153
18154 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
18155 capture response header Via len 20
18156
18157 # log the URL location during a redirection
18158 capture response header Location len 20
18159
18160 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
18161 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
18162 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18163 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
18164 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
18165
18166 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18167 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18168 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18169 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018170 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018171
18172 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
18173 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
18174 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
18175 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
18176 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018177 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018178
18179
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181808.9. Examples of logs
18181---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018182
18183These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
18184them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
18185reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
18186
18187 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
18188 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18189 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18190
18191 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
18192 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
18193
18194 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
18195 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
18196 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
18197
18198 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
18199 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
18200
18201 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
18202 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
18203 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
18204
18205 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018206 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018207 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
18208 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
18209
18210 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
18211 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
18212 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
18213
18214 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
18215 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020018216 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018217 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
18218 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
18219 to return the 502 and not the server.
18220
18221 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018222 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018223
18224 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
18225 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
18226 Nothing was sent to any server.
18227
18228 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
18229 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
18230
18231 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
18232 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018233 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018234 send a 408 return code to the client.
18235
18236 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
18237 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
18238
18239 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
18240 5 seconds ("c----").
18241
18242 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
18243 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018244 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018245
18246 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018247 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018248 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
18249 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
18250 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
18251 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
18252 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018253
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020018254
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200182559. Supported filters
18256--------------------
18257
18258Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
18259accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
18260unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
18261
18262See also : "filter"
18263
182649.1. Trace
18265----------
18266
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018267filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018268
18269 Arguments:
18270 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
18271 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
18272
18273 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
18274 the client and the server. By default, this filter
18275 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
18276 only parses a random amount of the available data.
18277
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018278 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018279 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
18280 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
18281 amount of the parsed data.
18282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018283 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010018284
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018285This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
18286callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
18287information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
18288filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
18289
18290Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
18291tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
18292a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
18293
18294
182959.2. HTTP compression
18296---------------------
18297
18298filter compression
18299
18300The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
18301keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018302when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
18303it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
18304response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
18305line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
18306cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
18307the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018308
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018309See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020018310
18311
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200183129.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
18313--------------------------------------------
18314
18315filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
18316
18317 Arguments :
18318
18319 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
18320 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
18321 parsed.
18322
18323 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
18324 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
18325 part must be placed in its own scope.
18326
18327The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
18328external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018329streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018330exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
18331also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
18332
18333SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
18334the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
18335
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018336For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020018337"doc/SPOE.txt".
18338
18339Important note:
18340 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
18341 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
18342
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100183439.4. Cache
18344----------
18345
18346filter cache <name>
18347
18348 Arguments :
18349
18350 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
18351
18352The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
18353"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roesler27c754c2019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018354cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018355other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
18356the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
18357mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
18358filter other than the compression is used for the same
18359listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
18360order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018361
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010018362See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018363
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001836410. Cache
18365---------
18366
18367HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
18368(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
18369RAM.
18370
18371The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018372this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018373
18374If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
18375independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
18376when we try to allocate a new one.
18377
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010018378The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018379
18380It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
18381"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
18382for more details.
18383
18384When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
18385replaced by "<CACHE>".
18386
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001838710.1. Limitation
18388----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018389
18390The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
18391
18392- If the response is not a 200
18393- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018394- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018395- If the response is not cacheable
18396
18397- If the request is not a GET
18398- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020018399- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018400
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010018401Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
18402filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
18403can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
18404example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
18405"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018406
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001840710.2. Setup
18408-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018409
18410To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
18411the corresponding http-request and response actions.
18412
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001841310.2.1. Cache section
18414---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018415
18416cache <name>
18417 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
18418 size of cache is mandatory.
18419
18420total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018421 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018422 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018423
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018424max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020018425 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
18426 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
18427 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020018428
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018429max-age <seconds>
18430 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
18431 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
18432 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
18433 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
18434 default.
18435
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001843610.2.2. Proxy section
18437---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018438
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018439http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018440 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
18441 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
18442 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
18443 after this one.
18444
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020018445http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010018446 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
18447 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
18448 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
18449 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
18450
18451
18452Example:
18453
18454 backend bck1
18455 mode http
18456
18457 http-request cache-use foobar
18458 http-response cache-store foobar
18459 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
18460
18461 cache foobar
18462 total-max-size 4
18463 max-age 240
18464
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018465/*
18466 * Local variables:
18467 * fill-column: 79
18468 * End:
18469 */